TLV320AIC3206 Application Reference Guide Reference Guide Literature Number: SLAA463B January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Chapter 1 SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 TLV320AIC3206 Overview • • • • • Chapter Chapter Chapter Chapter Chapter 1: 2: 3: 4: 5: Device Overview TLV320AIC3206 Application Device Initialization Example Setups Register Map and Descriptions space 2 Features Applications • Stereo Audio DAC with 100dB SNR • 5.8mW Stereo 48ksps DAC-to-Ground-Centered Headphone Playback • Stereo Audio ADC with 93dB SNR • 5.2mW Stereo 48ksps ADC Record • PowerTune™ • Extensive Signal Processing Options • Six Single-Ended or 3 Fully-Differential Analog Inputs • Stereo Analog and Digital Microphone Inputs • Ground-Centered Stereo Headphone Outputs • Stereo Line Outputs • Very Low-Noise PGA • Low Power Analog Bypass Mode • Programmable Microphone Bias • Programmable PLL • 5mm x 5mm 40-pin QFN or 3.5mm x 3.3mm 42ball WCSP Package • Portable Navigation Devices (PND) • Portable Media Player (PMP) • Mobile Handsets • Communication • Portable Computing The TLV320AIC3206 (sometimes referred to as the AIC3206) is a flexible, low-power, low-voltage stereo audio codec with programmable inputs and outputs, PowerTune capabilities, fullyprogrammable processing blocks, fixed predefined and parameterizable signal processing blocks, integrated PLL and flexible digital interfaces. Extensive register-based control of power, input/output channel configuration, gains, effects, pin-multiplexing and clocks is included, allowing the device to be precisely targeted to its application. TLV320AIC3206 Overview SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated Description www.ti.com 1.1 Description IN1_L IN2_L IN3_L 0…+47.5 dB + Left ADC tpl + * AGC DRC ADC Signal Proc. DAC Signal Proc. Vol . Ctrl * -6...+14dB + Left DAC HPL 1dB steps Gain Adj. 0.5 dB steps -6...+29dB -30...0 dB LOL + 1dB steps Data Interface -6...+29dB -30...0 dB LOR + 1dB steps 0… +47.5 dB + Gain Adj. Right ADC IN3_R + tpr * 0.5 dB steps IN2_R ADC Signal Proc. DAC Signal Proc. AGC DRC * -6...+14dB Right DAC HPR + 1dB steps Vol . Ctrl IN1_R GND_Sense SPI_Select SPI / I2C Control Block Reset MicBias MicDet Ref PLL Dig Mic Inter rupt Sec. I2S I/F Primary I2S Interface VNEG Charge Pump Mic Bias Supplies Fly_N Fly_P Pin Muxing / Clock Routing Ref DVDD_CP DVSS_CP BCLK WCLK DIN DOUT GPIO MCLK SCLK MISO SDA/MOSI SCL/SS IOVss (GND) DVss (GND) Avss (GND) GND IOVdd AVdd DVdd Vsys DRVdd_HP Figure 1-1. Simplified Block Diagram The TLV320AIC3206 features extensive register-based control of power, input/output channel configuration, gains, effects, pin-multiplexing and clocks is included, allowing the device to be precisely targeted to its application. The device can cover operations from 8kHz mono voice playback to audio stereo 192kHz DAC playback, making it ideal for portable battery-powered audio and telephony applications. The record path of the TLV320AIC3206 covers operations from 8kHz mono to 192kHz stereo recording, and contains programmable input channel configurations covering single-ended and differential setups, as well as floating or mixing input signals. It also includes a digitally-controlled stereo microphone preamplifier and integrated microphone bias. Digital signal processing blocks can remove audible noise that may be introduced by mechanical coupling, e.g. optical zooming in a digital camera. The playback path offers signal-processing blocks for filtering and effects, and supports flexible mixing of DAC and analog input signals as well as programmable volume controls. The playback path contains two high-power output drivers which eliminate the need for ac coupling capacitors. A built in charge pump generates the negative supply for the ground centered high powered output drivers. The high-power outputs can be configured in multiple ways, including stereo and mono BTL. The device can be programmed to various power-performance trade-offs. Mobile applications frequently have multiple use cases requiring very low power operation while being used in a mobile environment. When used in a docked environment power consumption typically is less of a concern, while minimizing noise is important. The TLV320AIC3206 addresses both cases. The device offers single supply operation from 1.5V-1.95V. Digital I/O voltages are supported in the range of 1.1V-3.6V. SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated TLV320AIC3206 Overview 3 Typical Circuit Configuration www.ti.com The required internal clock of the TLV320AIC3206 can be derived from multiple sources, including the MCLK pin, the BCLK pin, the GPIO pin or the output of the internal PLL, where the input to the PLL again can be derived from the MCLK pin, the BCLK or GPIO pins. Although using the PLL ensures the availability of a suitable clock signal, it is not recommended for the lowest power settings. The PLL is highly programmable and can accept available input clocks in the range of 512kHz to 50MHz. The device is available in the 5mm × 5mm, 40-pin QFN or 3.5mm x 3.3mm 42-ball WCSP package. 1.2 Typical Circuit Configuration Figure 1-2. Typical Circuit Configuration 4 TLV320AIC3206 Overview SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated Chapter 2 SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 TLV320AIC3206 Application 2.1 Terminal Descriptions 2.1.1 Digital Pins Only a small number of digital pins are dedicated to a single function; whenever possible, the digital pins have a default function, and also can be reprogrammed to cover alternative functions for various applications. The fixed-function pins are Reset and the SPI_Select pin, which are HW control pins. Depending on the state of SPI_Select, the two control-bus pins SCL/SS and SDA/MOSI are configured for either I2C or SPI protocol. Other digital IO pins can be configured for various functions via register control. An overview of available functionality is given in Section 2.1.1.1. 2.1.1.1 Multifunction Pins Table 2-1 shows the possible allocation of pins for specific functions. The PLL input, for example, can be programmed to be any of 4 pins (MCLK, BCLK, DIN, GPIO). Table 2-1. Multifunction Pin Assignments 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 MCLK BCLK WCLK DIN MFP1 DOUT MFP2 DMDIN/ MFP3/ SCLK DMCLK/ MFP4/ MISO GPIO MFP5 PLL Input S (1) S (2) B Codec Clock Input (1) C I2S BCLK input S,D D I2S BCLK output E (5) Pin Function A 2 E I S WCLK input F I2S WCLK output I S ADC word clock input H I2S ADC WCLK out I I2S DIN J I2S DOUT K General Purpose Output I K General Purpose Output II K General Purpose Output III L General Purpose Input I L General Purpose Input II L General Purpose Input III (2) (3) (4) (5) S S (3) E (2) S (3) E, D E 2 G (1) S ,D (4) E E E E E, D E, D E E E E E E S(1): The MCLK pin can drive the PLL and Codec Clock inputs simultaneously. S(2): The BCLK pin can drive the PLL and Codec Clock and audio interface bit clock inputs simultaneously. S(3): The GPIO/MFP5 pin can drive the PLL and Codec Clock inputs simultaneously. D: Default Function E: The pin is exclusively used for this function, no other function can be implemented with the same pin. (If GPIO/MFP5 has been allocated for General Purpose Output, it cannot be used as the INT1 output at the same time.) SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated TLV320AIC3206 Application 5 Terminal Descriptions www.ti.com Table 2-1. Multifunction Pin Assignments (continued) Pin Function 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 MCLK BCLK WCLK DIN MFP1 DOUT MFP2 DMDIN/ MFP3/ SCLK DMCLK/ MFP4/ MISO GPIO MFP5 M INT1 output E E E N INT2 output E E E 2 Q Secondary I S BCLK input E E R Secondary I2S WCLK in E E S Secondary I2S DIN E E 2 T Secondary I S DOUT U Secondary I2S BCLK OUT E E E E V Secondary I2S WCLK OUT E E E X Aux Clock Output E E E 2.1.2 Analog Pins Analog functions can also be configured to a large degree. For minimum power consumption, analog blocks are powered down by default. The blocks can be powered up with fine granularity according to the application needs. 6 TLV320AIC3206 Application SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated Terminal Descriptions www.ti.com 2.1.3 Register Settings for Multifunction Pins To configure the settings seen in Table 2-1, please see the letter-number combination in Table 2-2 for the appropriate registers to modify. Please be aware that more settings may be necessary to obtain a full interface definition matching the application requirement (see Page 0, Register 25 to 33). Table 2-2. Multifunction Pin Register Configuration Description Required Register Setting N5 INT2 output DOUT/MFP2 Page 0, Register 53,Bits D3-D1 = 101 Page 0, Register 4, Bits D3D2 = 01 N7 INT2 output on MISO/MFP4 Page 0, Register 55, Bits D4-D1 = 0101 PLL Input on DIN/MFP1 Page 0, Register 54, Bits D2-D1 = 01 Page 0, Register 4, Bits D3D2 = 11 N8 INT2 output on GPIO/MFP5 Page 0, Register 52, Bits D5-D2 = 0110 A8 PLL Input on GPIO/MFP5 Page 0, Register 52, Bits D5-D2 = 0001 Page 0, Register 4, Bits D3D2 = 10 O4 Digital Microphone Data Input on DIN/MFP1 Page 0, Register 54, Bits D2-D1 = 01 Page 0, Register 81, Bits D5-D4 = 10 B1 Codec Clock Input on MCLK Page 0, Register 4, Bits D1D0 = 00 O6 Digital Microphone Data Input on SCLK/MFP3 Page 0, Register 56, Bits D2-D1 = 01 Page 0, Register 81, Bits D5-D4 = 01 B2 Codec Clock Input on BCLK Page 0, Register 4, Bits D1D0 = 01 O8 Digital Microphone Data Input on GPIO/MFP5 Page 0, Register 52, Bits D5-D2 = 0001 Page 0, Register 81, Bits D5-D4 = 00 B8 Codec Clock Input on GPIO/MPF5 Page 0, Register 52, Bits D5-D2 = 0001 Page 0, Register 4, Bits D1D0 = 10 P7 Digital Microphone Clock Output on MISO/MFP4 Page 0, Register 55, Bits D4-D1 = 0111 C2 I2S BCLK input on BCLK Page 0, Register 27, Bit D3 =0 P8 Digital Microphone Clock Output on GPIO/MFP5 Page 0, Register 52, Bits D5-D2 = 1010 D2 I2S BCLK output on BCLK Page 0, Register 27, Bit D3 =1 Q6 Secondary I2S BCLK input on SCLK/MFP3 Page 0, Register 56, Bits D2-D1 = 01 Page 0, Register 31, Bits D6-D5 = 01 E3 I2S WCLK input on WCLK Page 0, Register 27, Bit D2 =0 Q8 Secondary I2S BCLK input on GPIO/MFP5 Page 0, Register 52, Bits D5-D2 = 0001 Page 0, Register 31, Bits D6-D5 = 00 F3 I2S WCLK output WCLK Page 0, Register 27, Bit D2 =1 R6 Page 0, Register 56, Bits Secondary I2S WCLK in on D2-D1 = 01 SCLK/MFP3 Page 0, Register 31, Bits D4-D3 = 01 G6 I2S ADC word clock input on SCLK/MFP3 Page 0, Register 56, Bits D2-D1 = 01 Page 0, Register 31, Bits D2-D1 = 01 R8 Page 0, Register 52, Bits Secondary I2S WCLK in on D5-D2 = 0001 GPIO/MFP50 Page 0, Register 31, Bits D4-D3 = 0 G8 I2S ADC word clock input on GPIO/MFP5 Page 0, Register 52, Bits D5-D2 = 0001 Page 0, Register 31, Bits D2-D1 = 00 S6 Secondary I2S DIN on SCLK/MFP3 Description Required Register Setting A1 PLL Input on MCLK Page 0, Register 4, Bits D3D2 = 00 A2 PLL Input on BCLK A4 SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated Page 0, Register 56, Bits D2-D1 = 01 Page 0, Register 31, Bit D0 =1 TLV320AIC3206 Application 7 Analog Audio I/O www.ti.com Table 2-2. Multifunction Pin Register Configuration (continued) 2.2 Description Required Register Setting S8 Secondary I2S DIN on GPIO/MFP5 Page 0, Register 52, Bits D5-D2 = 0001 Page 0, Register 31, Bit D0 =0 Page 0, Register 52, Bits D5-D2 = 0111 T7 Secondary I2S DOUT on MISO/MFP4 Page 0, Register 55, Bits D4-D1 = 1000 I2S DIN on DIN/MFP1 Page 0, Register 54, Bits D2-D1 = 01 U5 Secondary I2S BCLK OUT on DOUT/MFP2 Page 0, Register 53, Bits D3-D1 = 110 J5 I2S DOUT on DOUT/MFP2 Page 0, Register 53, Bits D3-D1 = 001 U7 Secondary I2S BCLK OUT on MISO/MFP4 Page 0, Register 55, Bits D4-D1 = 1001 K5 General Purpose Out I on Page 0, Register 53, Bits DOUT/MFP2 D3-D1 = 010 U8 Secondary I2S BCLK OUT on GPIO/MFP5 Page 0, Register 52, Bits D5-D2 = 1000 K7 General Purpose Out II on MISO/MFP4 Page 0, Register 55, Bits D4-D1 = 0010 V5 Secondary I2S WCLK OUT on SCLK/MFP3 Page 0, Register 53, Bits D3-D1 = 111 K8 General Purpose Out III on GPIO/MFP5 Page 0, Register 52, Bits D5-D2 = 0011 V7 Secondary I2S WCLK OUT on MISO/MFP4 Page 0, Register 55, Bits D4-D1 = 1010 L4 General Purpose In I on DIN/MFP1 Page 0, Register 54, Bits D2-D1 = 10 V8 Secondary I2S WCLK OUT on GPIO/MFP5 Page 0, Register 52, Bits D5-D2 = 1001 L6 General Purpose In II on SCLK/MFP3 Page 0, Register 56, Bits D2-D1 = 10 W6 Headset Detect Input on SCLK/MFP3 Page 0, Register 56, Bits D2-D1 = 00 Page 0, Register 67, Bit D7 =1 L8 General Purpose In III on GPIO/MFP5 Page 0, Register 52, Bits D5-D2 = 0010 X5 Aux Clock Output on DOUT/MFP2 Page 0, Register 53, Bits D3-D1 = 011 M5 INT1 output on DOUT/MFP2 Page 0, Register 53, Bits D3-D1 = 100 X7 Aux Clock Output on MISO/MFP4 Page 0, Register 55, Bits D4-D1 = 0011 M7 INT1 output on MISO/MFP4 Page 0, Register 55, Bits D4-D1 = 0100 X8 Aux Clock Output on GPIO/MFP5 Page 0, Register 52, Bits D5-D2 = 0100 M8 INT1 output on GPIO/MFP5 Page 0, Register 52, Bits D5-D2 = 0101 Description Required Register Setting H7 I2S ADC WCLK out on MISO/MFP4 Page 0, Register 55, Bits D4-D1 = 0110 H8 I2S ADC WCLK out on GPIO/MFP5 I4 Analog Audio I/O The analog IO path of the TLV320AIC3206 features a large set of options for signal conditioning as well as signal routing: • 6 analog inputs which can be mixed and-or multiplexed in single-ended and-or differential configuration • 2 programmable gain amplifiers (PGA) with a range of 0 to +47.5dB • 2 mixer amplifiers for analog bypass • 2 low power analog bypass channels • Mute function • Channel-to-channel phase adjustment • Fast charge of ac-coupling capacitors • Anti thump 2.2.1 Analog Bypass The TLV320AIC3206 offers two analog-bypass modes. In either of the modes, an analog input signal can be routed from an analog input pin to an amplifier driving an analog output pin. Neither the ADC nor the DAC resources are required for such operation. In analog low-power bypass mode, line-level signals can be routed directly from the analog inputs IN1_L to the left headphone amplifier (HPL) and IN1_R to HPR. 8 TLV320AIC3206 Application SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated Analog Audio I/O www.ti.com 2.2.2 ADC Bypass Using Mixer Amplifiers In addition to the analog low-power bypass mode, another bypass mode uses the programmable gain amplifiers of the input stage in conjunction with a mixer amplifier. With this mode, microphone-level signals can be amplified and routed to the line or headphone outputs, fully bypassing the ADC and DAC. To enable this mode, the mixer amplifiers are powered on via software command. In analog low-power bypass mode, line-level signals can be routed directly from the analog inputs IN1L to the left headphone amplifier (HPL) and IN1R to HPR. (Configured on Page 1, Register 12, Bit D2 for the left channel and Page 1, Register 13, Bit D2 for the right channel.) To use the mixer amplifiers, power them on via Page, Register 9, Bits D1-D0. 2.2.2.1 Analog Programmable Gain Amplifier (PGA) The TLV320AIC3206 features a built-in low-noise PGA for boosting low-level signals, such as direct microphone inputs, to full-scale to achieve high SNR. This PGA can provide a gain in the range of 0dB to 47.5dB for single-ended inputs or 6dB to 53.5dB for fully-differential inputs. See Section 2.3.2.1 for information on setting gains for the entire input path. 2.2.3 Headphone Output The stereo headphone drivers on pins HPL and HPR can drive loads with impedances down to 16Ω in single-ended DC-coupled headphone configurations. An integral charge pump generates the negative supply required to operate the headphone drivers in dc-coupled mode, where the common mode of the output signal is made equal to the ground of the headphone load using a ground-sense circuit. Operation of headphone drivers in dc-coupled (ground centered mode) eliminates the need for large dc-blocking capacitors. HPL HPR GND_SENSE Figure 2-1. TLV320AIC3206 Ground-Centered Headphone Output Alternatively the headphone amplifier can also be operated in a unipolar circuit configuration using DC blocking capacitors. 2.2.3.1 Using the Headphone Amplifier The headphone drivers are capable of driving a mixed combination of DAC signal, left and right ADC PGA signal and line-bypass from analog input IN1L and IN1R by configuring Page 1, Reg 12 and Page 1, Reg 13 respectively. The ADC PGA signals can be attenuated up to 30dB before routing to headphone drivers by configuring Page 1, Reg 24 and Page 1, Reg 25. The line-input signals can be attenuated up to 72dB before routing by configuring Page 1, Reg 22 and 23. The level of the DAC signal can be controlled using the digital volume control of the DAC in Page 0, Reg 65 and 66. To control the output-voltage swing of headphone drivers, the digital volume control provides a range of –6.0dB to +14.0dB in steps of 1dB. These can be configured by programming Page 1, Reg 16 and 17. These level controls are not meant to be used as dynamic volume control, but more to set output levels during initial device configuration. (1) (1) If the headphone amplifier must be placed into 'mute' from the –6.0dB setting, set the device at a gain of –5.0dB first, then place the device into mute. SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated TLV320AIC3206 Application 9 Analog Audio I/O 2.2.3.2 www.ti.com Ground-Centered Headphone Amplifier Configuration Among the other advantages of the ground-centered connection is inherent freedom from turn-on transients that can cause audible pops, sometimes at uncomfortable volumes. 2.2.3.2.1 Circuit Topology The power supply hook up scheme for the ground centered configuration is shown in Figure 2-2 DRVdd_HP pin supplies the positive side of the headphone amplifier. DVdd_CP pin supplies the charge pump which in turn supplies the negative side of the headphone amplifier. Two capacitors are required for the charge pump circuit to work. These capacitors should be X7R rated. 1.8...1.95V DVdd_CP DRVdd_HP 10 uF -6...+14dB HPL 1dB steps -6...+14dB HPR 1dB steps GND_Sense VNEG Charge Pump Fly_N Fly_P 2.2 uF X7R 2.2 uF X7R DVss_CP Figure 2-2. 2.2.3.2.2 Charge Pump Setup and Operation The built in charge pump draws charge from the DVDD_CP supply, and by switching the external capacitor between FLY_P and FLY_N, generates the negative voltage on VNEG pin. The charge-pump circuit uses the principles of switched-capacitor charge conservation to generate the VNEG supply in a very efficient fashion. To turn on the charge pump circuit, program Page 1, Register 1, D1:0 to “10”. When the charge pump circuit is disabled, VNEG acts as a ground terminal, allowing unipolar configuration of the headphone amps. By default, the charge pump is disabled. The switching rate of the charge pump can be controlled by Page 1, Register 124, D3:0. Because the charge pump can demand significant inrush currents from the supply, it is important to have a capacitor connected in close proximity to the DVdd_CP and DVss_CP pins of the device. At 500kHz clock rate this requires approximately a 10μF capacitor. The ESR and ESL of the capacitor must be low to allow fast switching currents. The ground-centered mode of operation is enabled by configuring Page 1, Reg 125, D4 after enabling the charge-pump. 2.2.3.2.3 Output Power Optimization The device can be optimized for a specific output-power range. The charge pump and the headphone driver circuitry can be reduced in power so less overall power is consumed. The headphone driver power can be programmed in Page 1, Register 125. The control of charge pump switching current is programmed in Page 1, Register 124. 2.2.3.2.4 Offset Correction and Start-Up The TLV320AIC3206 offers an offset-correction scheme that is based on calibration during power up. This scheme minimizes the differences in DC voltage between GND_SENSE and HPL and HPR outputs. 10 TLV320AIC3206 Application SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated Analog Audio I/O www.ti.com The offset calibration happens after the headphones are powered up in ground-centered configuration. All other headphone configurations like signal routings, gain settings and mute removal must be configured before headphone powerup. Any change in these settings while the headphones are powered up may result in additional offsets and are best avoided. The offset-calibration block has a few programmable parameters that the user must control. The user can either choose to calibrate the offset only for the selected input routing or all input configurations. The calibration data is stored in internal memory until the next hardware reset or until AVdd power is removed. Programming Page 1, Register 125, D(1:0) as “10” causes the offset to be calibrated for the selected input mode. Programming Page 1, Register 125, D(1:1) as “11” causes the offset to be calibrated for all possible configurations. All related blocks must be powered while doing offset correction. Programming Page 1, Reg 125, D (1:0) as “00” (default) disables the offset correction block. While the offset is being calibrated, no signal should be applied to the headphone amplifier. the DAC should be kept muted and analog bypass routing should be kept at the highest attenuation. The user can read Page 1, Register 2, D2 to poll if calibration is completed. D2 = ”1” indicates that calibration is completed. 2.2.3.2.5 Ground-Centered Headphone Setup There are four practical device setups for ground-centered operation, shown in Table 2-3: Table 2-3. Ground-Centered Headphone Setup Performance Options Audio Output Power High High Performance 16Ω Low Power Consumption 32Ω 600Ω 97.9dB SNR 94.1dB 96.6dB Output Power 26.2mW 23.4mW Idle Power Consumption 32Ω 600Ω 92.3dB 95.2dB 95.6dB 19.7mW 19.3mW 15.6mW High-Output, High-Performance Setup Medium 16Ω SNR 90.7dB Output Power 10.5mW 5.3mW Idle Power Consumption 11.9mW High-Output, Low-Power Setup 86.3dB 87.4dB 8.4dB 5.4mW 10.9mW Medium-Output, High-Performance Setup 87.4dB 86.3mW Medium-Output, Low-Power Setup High Audio Output Power, High Performance Setup This setup describe the register programming necessary to configure the device for a combination of high audio output power and high performance. To achieve this combination the parameters must be programmed to the values inTable 2-4. Table 2-4. Setup A - High Audio Output Power, High Performance Parameter Value CM 0.9 PTM PTM_P3 Processing Block Programming Page 1, Register 10, D6 = "0" 1 to 6, 22, 23, 24 "Page 1, Register 3, D4:D2 = ""000""Page 1, Register 4, D4:D2 = ""000""" Page 0, Register 60 DAC OSR 128 "Page 0, Register 13 = 0x00Page 0, Register 14 = 0x80" DAC perf setting high "Page 1, Register 3, D5 = ""0""Page 1, Register 4, D5 = ""0""" HP sizing 100 Page 1, Register 125, D3:D2 = "00" CP sizing 100 Page 1, Register 124, D6:D4 = "000" Gain 0 DVdd 1.26 "Page 1, Register 16, D5:D0 = ""00 0000""Page 1, Register 17, D5:D0 = ""00 0000""" Apply 1.26 to 1.95V AVdd,DRVdd_HP, DVdd_CP 1.8 Apply 1.8 to 1.95V SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated TLV320AIC3206 Application 11 Analog Audio I/O www.ti.com Medium Audio Output Power, High Performance Setup This setup describe the register programming necessary to configure the device for a combination of medium audio output power and high performance. To achieve this combination the parameters must be programmed to the values inTable 2-5 Table 2-5. Setup B - Medium Audio Output Power, High Performance Parameter Value CM 0.75 PTM PTM_P2 Processing Block DAC OSR 7 to 16 64 DAC perf setting Programming Page 1, Register 10, D6 = 1 "Page 1, Register 3, D4:D2 = ""001""Page 1, Register 4, D4:D2 = ""001""" Page 0, Register 60 "Page 0, Register 13 = 0x00Page 0, Register 14 = 0x40" low power "Page 1, Register 3, D5 = ""1""Page 1, Register 4, D5 = ""1""" HP sizing 100 Page 1, Register 125, D3:D2 = "00" CP sizing 100 Page 1, Register 124, D6:D4 = "000" Gain 5 "Page 1, Register 16, D5:D0 = ""00 0101""Page 1, Register 17, D5:D0 = ""00 0101""" DVdd 1.26 Apply 1.26 to 1.95V AVdd,DRVdd_HP, DVdd_CP 1.8 Apply 1.8 to 1.95V High Audio Output Power, Low Power Consumption Setup This setup describe the register programming necessary to configure the device for a combination of high audio output power and low power consumption. To achieve this combination the parameters must be programmed to the values inTable 2-6 Table 2-6. Setup C - High Audio Output Power, Low Power Consumption Parameter Value CM 0.75 PTM PTM_P2 Processing Block DAC OSR 7 to 16 64 Programming Page 1, Register 10, D6 = 1 "Page 1, Register 3, D4:D2 = ""001""Page 1, Register 4, D4:D2 = ""001""" Page 0, Register 60 "Page 0, Register 13 = 0x00Page 0, Register 14 = 0x40" DAC perf setting high "Page 1, Register 3, D5 = ""0""Page 1, Register 4, D5 = ""0""" HP sizing 100 Page 1, Register 125, D3:D2 = "00" CP sizing 100 Page 1, Register 124, D6:D4 = "000" Gain 5 "Page 1, Register 16, D5:D0 = ""00 0101""Page 1, Register 17, D5:D0 = ""00 0101""" DVdd 1.26 Apply 1.26 to 1.95V AVdd,DRVdd_HP, DVdd_CP 1.5 Apply 1.5 to 1.95V Medium Audio Output Power Setup, Lowest Power Consumption This setup describe the register programming necessary to configure the device for a combination of medium audio output power and lowest power consumption. To achieve this combination the parameters must be programmed to the values inTable 2-7 Table 2-7. Setup D - Medium Audio Output Power Setup, Lowest Power Consumption Parameter CM 0.75 PTM PTM_P1 Processing Block DAC OSR DAC perf setting HP sizing 12 Value TLV320AIC3206 Application 7 to 16 64 Page 1, Register 10, D6 = 1 "Page 1, Register 3, D4:D2 = ""010""Page 1, Register 4, D4:D2 = ""010""" Page 0, Register 60 "Page 0, Register 13 = 0x00Page 0, Register 14 = 0x40" low power 25 Programming "Page 1, Register 3, D5 = ""1""Page 1, Register 4, D5 = ""1""" Page 1, Register 125, D3:D2 = "11" SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated Analog Audio I/O www.ti.com Table 2-7. Setup D - Medium Audio Output Power Setup, Lowest Power Consumption (continued) Parameter CP sizing 2.2.3.3 Value Programming 12.5 Page 1, Register 124, D6:D4 = "001" Gain 14 DVdd 1.26 "Page 1, Register 16, D5:D0 = ""00 1110""Page 1, Register 17, D5:D0 = ""00 1110""" Apply 1.26 to 1.95V AVdd,DRVdd_HP, DVdd_CP 1.5 Apply 1.5 to 1.95V Stereo Unipolar Configuration 2.2.3.3.1 Circuit Topology The power supply hook up scheme for the unipolar configuration is shown in Figure 2-3 DRVdd_HP pin supplies the positive side of the headphone amplifier. The negative side is connected to ground potential (VNEG). TI recommends connecting the DVdd_CP pin to DVdd, although the charge pump must not be enabled while the device is connected in unipolar configuration. DVdd 1.5...3.6V DVdd DVdd_CP DRVdd_HP -6...+14dB HPL 1dB steps -6...+14dB HPR 1dB steps GND_Sense VNEG Charge Pump (disabled) Fly_N Fly_P DVss_CP Figure 2-3. Unipolar Stereo Headphone Circuit The left and right DAC channels are routed to the corresponding left and right headphone amplifier. This configuration is also used to drive line-level loads. 2.2.3.3.2 Unipolar Turn-On Transient (Pop) Reduction The TLV320AIC3206 headphone drivers also support pop-free operation in unipolar, ac-coupled configuration. Because the HPL and HPR are high-power drivers, pop can result due to sudden transient changes in the output drivers if care is not taken. The most critical care is required while using the drivers as stereo single-ended capacitively-coupled drivers as shown in Figure 2-3. The output drivers achieve pop-free power-up by using slow power-up modes. Conceptually, the circuit during power-up can be visualized as SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated TLV320AIC3206 Application 13 Analog Audio I/O www.ti.com Cc Output Driver Rpop PAD Rload Figure 2-4. Conceptual Circuit for Pop-Free Power-up Set the value of Rpop by writing register Page 1, Register 20, Bits D1-D0. Table 2-8. Rpop Values Page 1, Register 20, Bits D1-D0 Rpop Value 00 2 kΩ 01 6 kΩ 10 25 kΩ To minimize audible artifacts, two parameters can be adjusted to match application requirements. The voltage Vload across Rload at the beginning of slow charging should not be more than a few mV. At that time the voltage across Rload can be determined as: V load = R load R load + R pop ´ V cm (1) For a typical Rload of 32Ω, Rpop of 6 kΩ or 25 kΩ delivers good results (see Table 2-8 for register settings). According to the conceptual circuit in Figure 2-4, the voltage on PAD will exponentially settle to the output common-mode voltage based on the value of Rpop and Cc. Thus, the output drivers must be in slow powerup mode for time T, such that at the end of the slow power-on period, the voltage on Vpad is very close to the common-mode voltage. The TLV320AIC3206 allows the time T to be adjusted to allow for a wide range of Rload and Cc by programming Page 1, Register 20, Bits D5-D2. For the time adjustments, the value of Cc is assumed to be 47μF. N = 5 is expected to yield good results. Page 1, Register 20, Bits D5-D2 Slow Charging Time = N*Time – Constants (for Rpop and 47μF) 14 0000 N=0 0001 N = 0.5 0010 N = 0.625 0011 N = 0.75 0100 N = 0.875 0101 N = 1.0 0110 N = 2.0 0111 N = 3.0 1000 N = 4.0 1001 N = 5.0 1010 N = 6.0 1011 N = 7.0 1100 N = 8.0 1101 N = 16 (Not valid for Rpop = 25kΩ) 1110 N = 24 (Not valid for Rpop = 25kΩ) 1111 N = 32 (Not valid for Rpop = 25kΩ) TLV320AIC3206 Application SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated Analog Audio I/O www.ti.com Again, for example, for Rload = 32Ω, Cc = 47μF and common mode of 0.9V, the number of time constants required for pop-free operation is 5 or 6. A higher or lower Cc value will require higher or lower value for N. During the slow-charging period, no signal is routed to the output driver. Therefore, choosing a larger than necessary value of N results in a delay from power-up to signal at output. At the same time, choosing N to be smaller than the optimal value results in poor pop performance at power-up. The signals being routed to headphone drivers (such as DAC and IN1) often have DC offsets due to lessthan-ideal processing. As a result, when these signals are routed to output drivers, the offset voltage causes a pop. To improve the pop-performance in such situations, a feature is provided to soft-step the DC-offset. At the beginning of the signal routing, a high-value attenuation can be applied which can be progressively reduced in steps until the desired gain in the channel is reached. The time interval between each of these gain changes can be controlled by programming Page 1, Register 20, Bits D7-D6. This gain soft-stepping is applied only during the initial routing of the signal to the output driver and not during subsequent gain changes. Page 1, Register 20, Bits D7-D6 Soft-stepping Step Time During initial signal routing 00 0 ms (soft-stepping disabled) 01 50ms 10 100ms 11 200ms The following sequence is recommended to achieve optimal pop performance at power-up: 1. Choose the value of Rpop, N (time constants) and soft-stepping step time for slow power-up. 2. Choose the configuration for output drivers, including common modes and output stage power connections 3. Select the signals to be routed to headphones. 4. Power up the blocks driving signals into HPL and HPR, but keep HPL and HPR muted 5. Unmute HPL and HPR and set the desired gain setting. 6. Power on the HPL and HPR drivers. 7. Unmute the block driving signals to HPL and HPR after the Driver PGA flags are set to indicate completion of soft-stepping after power-up. These flags can be read from Page 1, Register 63, Bits D7D6. Configure the Headphone Output driver depop control registers before powering up the headphone; these register contents must not be changed when the headphone drivers are powered up. Before powering down the HPL and HPR drivers, it is recommended that software read back the flags in Page 1, Register 63. For example. before powering down the HPL driver, ensure that bit D(7) = 1 and bit D(3) = 1 if IN1L is routed to HPL and bit D(1) = 1 if the Left Mixer is routed to HPL. The output driver should be powered down only after a steady-state power-up condition has been achieved. This steady state power-up condition also must be satisfied for changing the HPL-R driver mute control in Page 1, Register 16 and 17, Bits D7, for example. Mute and unmute the headphone drivers after the gain and volume controls associated with routing to HPL and HPR finish soft-stepping. In the differential configuration of HPL and HPR, when no coupling capacitor is used, the slow charging method for pop-free performance need not be used. In the differential load configuration for HPL and HPR, using the output driver MUTE feature is not recommended, because a pop may result. During the power-down state, the headphone outputs are weakly pulled to ground using an approximately 50kΩ resistor to ground, to maintain the output voltage on HPL and HPR pins. SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated TLV320AIC3206 Application 15 Analog Audio I/O 2.2.3.4 www.ti.com Mono Differential DAC to Mono Differential Headphone Output HPL LEFT_DACP LEFT DAC LEFT_DACM HPR Figure 2-5. Low Power Mono DAC to Differential Headphone This configuration, available in unipolar configuration of the HP amplifier supplies, supports the routing of the two differential outputs of the mono, left channel DAC to the headphone amplifiers in differential mode (Page 1, Register 12, D3 = 1 and Page 1, Register 13, D4 = 1). 2.2.4 Line Outputs The stereo line level drivers on LOL and LOR pins can drive a wide range of line level resistive impedances in the range of 600Ω to 10kΩ. The output common modes of line level drivers can be configured to equal either the analog input common-mode setting, or 1.65V. With output common-mode setting of 1.65V and DRVdd_HP supply at 3.3V the line-level drivers can drive up to 1Vrms output signal. The line-level drivers can drive out a mixed combination of DAC signal and attenuated ADC PGA signal. Signal mixing is register-programmable. 2.2.4.1 Line Out Amplifier Configurations Signal mixing can be configured by programming Page 1, Register 14 and 15. Additionally, the two linelevel drivers can be configured to act as a mono differential line level driver by routing the output of LOR to LOL (Page 1, Register 14, D(0) = 1). The output of DAC can be simultaneously played back to the stereo headphone drivers as well as stereo line- level drivers. In such a case, the DAC signal at the headphone outputs and line outputs are out-ofphase with respect to each other. LOL LOR Figure 2-6. Stereo Single-Ended Line-out 16 TLV320AIC3206 Application SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated ADC www.ti.com LOL Output + RIGHT_DACP RIGHT DAC AFIR LOR RIGHT_DACM Output - Figure 2-7. Low Power Mono DAC to Differential Line-out 2.3 ADC The TLV320AIC3206 includes a stereo audio ADC, which uses a delta-sigma modulator with a programmable oversampling ratio, followed by a digital decimation filter. The ADC supports sampling rates from 8kHz to 192kHz. In order to provide optimal system power management, the stereo recording path can be powered up one channel at a time, to support the case where only mono record capability is required. The ADC path of the TLV320AIC3206 features a large set of options for signal conditioning as well as signal routing: • Two ADCs • Six analog inputs which can be mixed and-or multiplexed in single-ended and-or differential configuration • Two programmable gain amplifiers (PGA) with a range of 0 to +47.5dB • Two mixer amplifiers for analog bypass • Two low power analog bypass channels • Fine gain adjustment of digital channels with 0.1dB step size • Digital volume control with a range of -12 to +20dB • Mute function In addition to the standard set of ADC features the TLV320AIC3206 also offers the following special functions: • Channel-to-channel phase adjustment • Fast charge of ac-coupling capacitors • Anti thump • Adaptive filter mode Because of the oversampling nature of the audio ADC and the integrated digital decimation filtering, requirements for analog anti-aliasing filtering are very relaxed. The TLV320AIC3206 integrates a second order analog anti-aliasing filter with 28-dB attenuation at 6MHz. This filter, combined with the digital decimation filter, provides sufficient anti-aliasing filtering without requiring additional external components. 2.3.1 ADC Signal Routing The TLV320AIC3206 includes six analog inputs which can be configured as either 3 stereo single-ended pairs or 3 fully-differential pairs. These pins connect through series resistors and switches to the virtual ground terminals of two fully-differential amplifiers (one per ADC-PGA channel). By turning on only one set of switches per amplifier at a time, the inputs can be effectively multiplexed to each ADC PGA channel. By turning on multiple sets of switches per amplifier at a time, audio sources can be mixed. The TLV320AIC3206 supports the ability to mix up to four single-ended analog inputs or up to two fullydifferential analog inputs into each ADC PGA channel. SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated TLV320AIC3206 Application 17 ADC www.ti.com In most applications, high input impedance is desired for analog inputs. However, when used in conjunction with high gain as in the case of microphone inputs, the higher input impedance results in higher noise or lower dynamic range. The TLV320AIC3206 allows the user the flexibility of choosing the input impedance from 10kΩ, 20kΩ and 40kΩ. When multiple inputs are mixed together, by choosing different input impedances, level adjustment can be achieved. For example, if one input is selected with 10kΩ input impedance and the second input is selected with 20kΩ input impedance, then the second input is attenuated by half as compared to the first input. Note that this input level control is not intended to be a volume control, but instead used occasionally for level setting. Mixing of multiple inputs can easily lead to PGA outputs that exceed the range of the internal amplifiers, resulting in saturation and clipping of the mixed output signal. Whenever mixing is being implemented, the system designer is advised to take adequate precautions to avoid such a saturation from occurring. In general, the mixed signal should not exceed 0dB. Typically, voice or audio signal inputs are capacitively coupled to the device. Capacitive coupling allows the device to independently set the common mode of the input signals to values chosen by the contents of Page 1, Register 10, D(6) to either 0.9V or 0.75V. The correct value maximizes the dynamic range across the entire analog-supply range. Failure to capacitively connect the input to the device can cause high offset due to mismatch in source common-mode and device common-mode setting, and in extreme cases, could also saturate the analog channel, causing distortion. 2.3.2 ADC Gain Setting Input Selection Analog Gain Digital Volume Control Frequency Response and Gain Digital Gain Adjust Audio Interface Analog In ADC Filtering PGA ADC 0, -6, -12 dB 0...47.5 dB Step = 0.5 dB Fully -12...20 dB 0…-0.4 dB Programmable Step = 0.5 dB Step = 0.1 dB Coefficients When the gain of the ADC Channel is kept at 0dB and the common mode set to 0.75V, a single-ended input of 0.375VRMS results in a full-scale digital signal at the output of ADC channel. Similarly, when the gain is kept at 0dB, and common mode is set to 0.9V, a single-ended input of 0.5VRMS results in a fullscale digital signal at the output of the ADC channel. However various block functions control the gain through the channel. The gain applied by the PGA is described in Table 2-9. Additionally, the digital volume control adjusts the gain through the channel as described in Section 2.3.2.2. A finer level of gain is controlled by fine gain control as described in Section 2.3.2.2.1. The decimation filters A, B and C along with the delta-sigma modulator contribute to a DC gain of 1.0 through the channel. 2.3.2.1 Analog Programmable Gain Amplifier (PGA) The TLV320AIC3206 features a built-in low-noise PGA for boosting low-level signals, such as direct microphone inputs, to full-scale to achieve high SNR. This PGA provides a gain in the range of 0dB to 47.5dB for single-ended inputs or 6dB to 53.5dB for fully-differential inputs (gain calculated w.r.t. input impedance setting of 10kΩ, 20kΩ input impedance will result in 6dB lower and 40kΩ will result in 12dB lower gain). The user can control the gain by writing to Page 1, Register 59 and Page 1, Register 60. In the AGC mode, this gain is optionally automatically controlled by the built-in hardware AGC. Table 2-9. Analog PGA versus Input Configuration 18 Page 1, Register 59, D(6:0) Page 1, Register 60, D(6:0) EFFECTIVE GAIN APPLIED BY PGA RIN = 10kΩ RIN = 20kΩ RIN = 40kΩ RIN = 10kΩ RIN = 20kΩ RIN = 40kΩ 000 0000 0dB –6dB -12dB 6.0dB 0dB –6.0dB 000 0001 0.5dB –5.5dB –11.5dB 6.5dB 0.5dB -5.5dB 000 0010 1.0dB –5.0dB –11.0dB 7.0dB 7.5dB –5.0dB TLV320AIC3206 Application SINGLE-ENDED DIFFERENTIAL SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated ADC www.ti.com Table 2-9. Analog PGA versus Input Configuration (continued) Page 1, Register 59, D(6:0) Page 1, Register 60, D(6:0) EFFECTIVE GAIN APPLIED BY PGA RIN = 10kΩ RIN = 20kΩ RIN = 40kΩ RIN = 10kΩ RIN = 20kΩ RIN = 40kΩ … … … … … … … 101 1110 47.0dB 41.0dB 35.0dB 53.0dB 47.0dB 41.0dB 101 1111 47.5dB 41.5dB 35.5dB 53.5dB 47.5dB 41.5dB SINGLE-ENDED DIFFERENTIAL The gain changes are implemented with an internal soft-stepping algorithm that only changes the actual volume level by one 0.5dB step every one or two ADC output samples, depending on the register value (see registers Page 0, Reg 81, D(1:0)). This soft-stepping smooths volume control changes with no audible artifacts. On reset, the PGA gain defaults to a mute condition, and at power down, the PGA softsteps the volume to mute before shutting down. A read-only flag Page 0, Reg 36, D(7) and D(3) is set whenever the gain applied by the PGA equals the desired value set by the register. The soft-stepping control can also be disabled by programming Page 0, Reg 81, D(1:0). 2.3.2.2 Digital Volume Control The TLV320AIC3206 also has a digital volume-control block with a range from -12dB to +20dB in steps of 0.5dB. The system controls the volume by programming Page 0, Register 83 and 84 respectively for left and right channels. Table 2-10. Digital Volume Control for ADC Desired Gain dB Left or Right Channel Page 1, Register 83 or 84 (respectively), D(6:0) –12.0 110 1000 –11.5 110 1001 –11.0 110 1010 .. –0.5 111 1111 0.0 000 0000 (Default) +0.5 000 0001 .. +19.5 010 0111 +20.0 010 1000 During volume control changes, using the soft-stepping feature avoids audible artifacts. The soft-stepping rate can be set to either 1 or 2 gain steps per sample. Soft-stepping can also be entirely disabled. This soft-stepping is configured via Page 1, Register 81, D(1:0), and is common to the soft-stepping control for the analog PGA. During power-down of an ADC channel, this volume control soft-steps down to –12.0dB before powering down. Due to the soft-stepping control, soon after changing the volume control setting or powering down the ADC channel, the actual applied gain may be different from the one programmed through the control register. The TLV320AIC3206 gives feedback to the user, through read-only flags Page 1, Reg 36, D(7) for Left Channel and Page 1, Reg 36, D(3) for the right channel. 2.3.2.2.1 Fine Digital Gain Adjustment Additionally, the gain in each of the channels is finely adjustable in steps of 0.1dB. This granularity is useful when trying to match the gain between channels. By programming Page 0, Register 82 the gain can be adjusted from 0dB to -0.4dB in steps of 0.1dB. This feature, in combination with the regular digital volume control, allows the gains through the left and right channels be matched in the range of -0.5dB to +0.5dB with a resolution of 0.1dB. SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated TLV320AIC3206 Application 19 ADC www.ti.com 2.3.2.3 AGC The TLV320AIC3206 includes Automatic Gain Control (AGC) for ADC recording. AGC can be used to maintain a nominally-constant output level when recording speech. As opposed to manually setting the PGA gain, in the AGC mode, the circuitry automatically adjusts the PGA gain as the input signal becomes overly loud or very weak, such as when a person speaking into a microphone moves closer or farther from the microphone. The AGC algorithm has several programmable parameters, including target gain, attack and decay time constants, noise threshold, and max PGA applicable, that allow the algorithm to be fine tuned for any particular application. The algorithm uses the absolute average of the signal (which is the average of the absolute value of the signal) as a measure of the nominal amplitude of the output signal. Since the gain can be changed at the sample interval time, the AGC algorithm operates at the ADC sample rate. 1. Target Level represents the nominal output level at which the AGC attempts to hold the ADC output signal level. The TLV320AIC3206 allows programming of eight different target levels, which can be programmed from –5.5dB to –24dB relative to a full-scale signal. Since the TLV320AIC3206 reacts to the signal absolute average and not to peak levels, it is recommended that the target level be set with enough margin to avoid clipping at the occurrence of loud sounds. 2. Attack Time defines how quickly the AGC circuitry reduces the PGA gain when the output signal level exceeds the target level due to increase in input signal level. Wide range of attack time programmability is supported in terms of number of samples (number of ADC sample frequency clock cycles). 3. Decay Time defines how quickly the PGA gain is increased when the output signal level falls below the target level due to reduction in input signal level. Wide range of decay time programmability is supported in terms of number of samples. 4. Gain Hysteresis is the hysteresis applied to the required gain calculated by the AGC function while changing its mode of operation from attack to decay or vice-versa. For example, while attacking the input signal, if the current applied gain by the AGC is xdB, and suddenly because of the input level going down, the new calculated required gain is ydB, then this gain is applied, provided that y is greater than x by the value set in Gain Hysteresis. This feature avoids the condition where the AGC function fluctuates between a very narrow band of gains leading to audible artifacts. The Gain Hysteresis can be adjusted or disabled by the user. 5. Noise threshold defines the level below which if the input signal level falls, the AGC considers it as silence, and thus brings down the gain to 0dB in steps of 0.5dB every fS and sets the noise threshold flag. The gain stays at 0dB unless the input speech signal average rises above the noise threshold setting. This noise-gating ensures that noise is not 'gained up' in the absence of speech. Noise threshold level in the AGC algorithm is programmable from -30dB to -90dB of full-scale. When AGC Noise Threshold is set to –70dB, –80dB, or –90dB, the microphone input Max PGA applicable setting must be greater than or equal to 11.5dB, 21.5dB, or 31.5dB respectively. This operation includes hysteresis and debounce to avoid the AGC gain from cycling between high gain and 0dB when signals are near the noise threshold level. The noise (or silence) detection feature can be entirely disabled by the user. 6. Max PGA applicable allows the designer to restrict the maximum gain applied by the AGC. This feature limits PGA gain in situations where environmental noise is greater than the programmed noise threshold. Microphone input Max PGA is programmable from 0dB to 58dB in steps of 0.5dB. 7. Hysteresis, as the name suggests, defines a window around the Noise Threshold which must be exceeded to either detect that the recorded signal is indeed noise or signal. If initially the energy of the recorded signal is greater than the Noise Threshold, then the AGC recognizes it as noise only when the energy of the recorded signal falls below the Noise Threshold by a value given by Hysteresis. Similarly, after the recorded signal is recognized as noise, for the AGC to recognize it as a signal, its energy must exceed the Noise Threshold by a value given by the Hysteresis setting. In order to prevent the AGC from jumping between noise and signal states, (which can happen when the energy of recorded signal is very close to the Noise threshold) a non-zero hysteresis value should be chosen. The Hysteresis feature can also be disabled. 8. Debounce Time (Noise and Signal) defines the hysteresis in time domain for noise detection. The AGC continuously calculates the energy of the recorded signal. If the calculated energy is less than the set Noise Threshold, then the AGC does not increase the input gain to achieve the Target Level. However, to handle audible artifacts which can occur when the energy of the input signal is very close to the Noise Threshold, the AGC checks if the energy of the recorded signal is less than the Noise 20 TLV320AIC3206 Application SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated ADC www.ti.com Threshold for a time greater than the Noise Debounce Time. Similarly the AGC starts increasing the input-signal gain to reach the Target Level when the calculated energy of the input signal is greater than the Noise Threshold. Again, to avoid audible artifacts when the input-signal energy is very close to Noise Threshold, the energy of the input signal needs to continuously exceed the Noise Threshold value for the Signal Debounce Time. If the debounce times are kept very small, then audible artifacts can result by rapid enabling and disabling the AGC function. At the same time, if the Debounce time is kept too large, then the AGC may take time to respond to changes in levels of input signals with respect to Noise Threshold. Both noise and signal debounce time can be disabled. 9. The AGC Noise Threshold Flag is a read-only flag indicating that the input signal has levels lower than the Noise Threshold, and thus is detected as noise (or silence). In such a condition the AGC applies a gain of 0dB. 10. Gain Applied by AGC is the gain applied by the AGC to the recorded signal in a read-only register to provide real-time feedback to the system. This value, along with the Target Setting, can be used to detect the input signal level. In a steady state situation Target Level (dB ) = Gain Applied by AGC (dB) + Input Signal Level (dB) When the AGC noise threshold flag is set, then the status of gain applied by AGC should be ignored. 11. The AGC Saturation Flag is a read-only flag indicating that the ADC output signal has not reached its Target Level. However, the AGC is unable to increase the gain further because the required gain is higher than the Maximum Allowed PGA gain. Such a situation can happen when the input signal has very low energy and the Noise Threshold is also set very low. When the AGC noise threshold flag is set, the status of the AGC saturation flag should be ignored. 12. The ADC Saturation Flag is a read-only flag indicating an overflow condition in the ADC channel. On overflow, the signal is clipped and distortion results. This condition typically happens when the AGC Target Level is kept very high and the energy in the input signal increases faster than the Attack Time. 13. An AGC low-pass filter detects the average level of the input signal. This average level is compared to the programmed detection levels in the AGC to provide the correct functionality. This low pass filter is in the form of a first-order IIR filter. Three 8-bit registers form the 24-bit digital coefficient as shown on the register map. A total of 9 registers are programmed to form the 3 IIR coefficients. The transfer function of the filter implemented for signal level detection is given by H( z) = N0 + N1z -1 2 23 - D1z -1 (2) Where: Coefficient N0 can be programmed by writing into Page 8, Register 12, 13 and 14. Coefficient N1 can be programmed by writing into Page 8, Register 16, 17 and 18. Coefficient D1 can be programmed by writing into Page 8, Register 20, 21 and 22. N0, N1 and D1 are 24-bit 2’s complement numbers and their default values implement a low-pass filter with cut-off at 0.002735*ADC_FS. See Table 2-11 for various AGC programming options. AGC can be used only if analog microphone input is routed to the ADC channel. Table 2-11. AGC Parameter Settings Function Control Register Left ADC Control Register Right ADC Bit AGC enable Page 0, Register 86 Page 0,Register 94 D(7) Target Level Page 0, Register 86 Page 0, Register 94 D(6:4) Gain Hysteresis Page 0, Register 86 Page 0, Register 94 D(1:0) Hysteresis Page 0, Register 87 Page 0, Register 95 D(7:6) Noise threshold Page 0, Register 87 Page 0, Register 95 D(5:1) Max PGA applicable Page 0, Register 88 Page 0, Register 96 D(6:0) Time constants (attack time) Page 0, Register 89 Page 0, Register 97 D(7:0) Time constants(decay time) Page 0, Register 90 Page 0, Register 98 D(7:0) Debounce time (Noise) Page 0, Register 91 Page 0, Register 99 D(4:0) Debounce time (Signal) Page 0, Register 92 Page 0, Register 100 D(3:0) Gain applied by AGC Page 0, Register 93 Page 0, Register 101 D(7:0) (Read Only) SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated TLV320AIC3206 Application 21 ADC www.ti.com Table 2-11. AGC Parameter Settings (continued) Function Control Register Left ADC Control Register Right ADC Bit AGC Noise Threshold Flag Page 0, Register 45 (sticky flag), Page 0, Register 47 (non-sticky flag) Page 0, Register 45 (sticky flag), D(6:5) (Read Only) Page 0, Register 47 (non-sticky flag) AGC Saturation flag Page 0, Register 36 (sticky flag) Page 0, Register 36 (sticky flag) ADC Saturation flag Page 0, Register 42 (sticky flag), Page 0, Register 43 (non-sticky flag) Page 0, Register 42 (sticky flag), D(3:2) (Read Only) Page 0, Register 43 (non-sticky flag) D(5), D(1) (Read Only) Input Signal Output Signal Target Level AGC Gain Attack Time Decay Time Figure 2-8. AGC Characteristics 2.3.3 ADC Decimation Filtering and Signal Processing Overview The TLV320AIC3206 ADC channel includes a built-in digital decimation filter to process the oversampled data from the to generate digital data at Nyquist sampling rate with high dynamic range. The decimation filter can be chosen from three different types, depending on the required frequency response, group delay and sampling rate. ADC Processing Blocks The TLV320AIC3206 offers a range of processing blocks which implement various signal processing capabilities along with decimation filtering. These processing blocks give users the choice of how much and what type of signal processing they may use and which decimation filter is applied. The choice between these processing blocks is part of the PowerTune strategy to balance power conservation and signal-processing flexibility. Less signal-processing capability reduces the power consumed by the device. Table 2-12 gives an overview of the available processing blocks and their properties. The Resource Class Column (RC) gives an approximate indication of power consumption. The signal processing blocks available are: • First-order IIR • Scalable number of biquad filters 22 TLV320AIC3206 Application SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated ADC www.ti.com • Variable-tap FIR filter The processing blocks are tuned for common cases and can achieve high anti-alias filtering or low group delay in combination with various signal processing effects such as audio effects and frequency shaping. The available first order IIR, BiQuad and FIR filters have fully user-programmable coefficients. The Resource Class Column (RC) gives an approximate indication of power consumption. Table 2-12. ADC Processing Blocks Processing Blocks Channel Decimation Filter 1st Order IIR Available Number BiQuads FIR Required AOSR Value Resource Class PRB_R1 (1) Stereo A Yes 0 No 128,64 6 PRB_R2 Stereo A Yes 5 No 128,64 8 PRB_R3 Stereo A Yes 0 25-Tap 128,64 8 PRB_R4 Right A Yes 0 No 128,64 3 PRB_R5 Right A Yes 5 No 128,64 4 PRB_R6 Right A Yes 0 25-Tap 128,64 4 PRB_R7 Stereo B Yes 0 No 64 3 PRB_R8 Stereo B Yes 3 No 64 4 PRB_R9 Stereo B Yes 0 20-Tap 64 4 PRB_R10 Right B Yes 0 No 64 2 PRB_R11 Right B Yes 3 No 64 2 PRB_R12 Right B Yes 0 20-Tap 64 2 PRB_R13 Stereo C Yes 0 No 32 3 PRB_R14 Stereo C Yes 5 No 32 4 PRB_R15 Stereo C Yes 0 25-Tap 32 4 PRB_R16 Right C Yes 0 No 32 2 PRB_R17 Right C Yes 5 No 32 2 PRB_R18 Right C Yes 0 25-Tap 32 2 (1) 2.3.3.1 Default Signal Processing Blocks – Details 2.3.3.1.1 First-Order IIR, AGC, Filter A From Delta-Sigma Modulator Filter A ´ st 1 Order IIR AGC Gain Compensation To Audio Interface AGC From Digital Vol. Ctrl To Analog PGA Figure 2-9. Signal Chain for PRB_R1 and PRB_R4 SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated TLV320AIC3206 Application 23 ADC www.ti.com 2.3.3.1.2 5 Biquads, First-Order IIR, AGC, Filter A From Delta-Sigma Modulator Filter A HA HB HC HD HE st 1 Order IIR ´ AGC Gain Compensation To Audio Interface AGC From Digital Vol. Ctrl To Analog PGA Figure 2-10. Signal Chain PRB_R2 and PRB_R5 2.3.3.1.3 25 Tap FIR, First-Order IIR, AGC, Filter A AGC Gain Compensation st From Delta-Sigma Modulator Filter A 1 Order IIR ´ 25-Tap FIR To Audio Interface AGC From Digital Vol. Ctrl To Analog PGA Figure 2-11. Signal Chain for PRB_R3 and PRB_R6 2.3.3.1.4 First-Order IIR, AGC, Filter B From Delta-Sigma Modulator AGC Gain Compensation st Filter B ´ 1 Order IIR To Audio Interface To Audio Interface AGC From Digital Vol. Ctrl To Analog PGA Figure 2-12. Signal Chain for PRB_R7 and PRB_R10 2.3.3.1.5 3 Biquads, First-Order IIR, AGC, Filter B From Delta-Sigma Modulator Filter B HA HB HC ´ 1stOrder IIR AGC Gain Compensation To Audio Interface AGC From Digital Vol. Ctrl To Analog PGA Figure 2-13. Signal Chain for PRB_R8 and PRB_R11 24 TLV320AIC3206 Application SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated ADC www.ti.com 2.3.3.1.6 20 Tap FIR, First-Order IIR, AGC, Filter B AGC Gain Compensation st From Delta-Sigma Modulator 20-Tap FIR Filter B 1 Order IIR ´ To Audio Interface AGC From Digital Vol. Ctrl To Analog PGA Figure 2-14. Signal Chain for PRB_R9 and PRB_R12 2.3.3.1.7 First-Order IIR, AGC, Filter C From Delta-Sigma Modulator Filter C ´ AGC Gain Compensation st 1 Order IIR To Audio Interface AGC From Digital Vol. Ctrl To Analog PGA Figure 2-15. Signal Chain for PRB_R13 and PRB_R16 2.3.3.1.8 5 Biquads, First-Order IIR, AGC, Filter C From Delta-Sigma Modulator Filter C HA HB HC HD HE ´ st 1 Order IIR AGC Gain Compensation To Audio Interface AGC From Digital Vol. Ctrl To Analog PGA Figure 2-16. Signal Chain for PRB_R14 and PRB_R17 2.3.3.1.9 25 Tap FIR, First-Order IIR, AGC, Filter C From Delta-Sigma Modulator st Filter C 25-Tap FIR ´ 1 Order IIR AGC Gain Compen sation To Audio Interface AGC From Digital Vol. Ctrl To Analog PGA Figure 2-17. Signal for PRB_R15 and PRB_R18 SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated TLV320AIC3206 Application 25 ADC www.ti.com 2.3.3.1.10 User Programmable Filters Depending on the selected processing block, different types and orders of digital filtering are available. A first order IIR filter is always available, and is useful to efficiently filter out possible DC components of the signal. Up to 5 biquad sections, or alternatively up to 25-tap FIR filters are available for specific processing blocks. The coefficients of the available filters are arranged as sequentially indexed coefficients in two banks. If adaptive filtering is chosen, the coefficient banks can be switched during operation without disruption. For more details on adaptive filtering see Section 2.3.3.2.7 below. The coefficients of these filters are each 24-bits wide, in two's-complement and occupy 3 consecutive 8-bit registers in the register space. For default values please see Section 5.11. 2.3.3.1.10.1 First-Order IIR Section The transfer function for the first order IIR Filter is given by H( z) = N0 + N1z -1 2 23 - D1z -1 (3) The frequency response for the first-order IIR Section with default coefficients is flat at a gain of 0dB. Details on ADC coefficient default values are given in Section 5.11. Table 2-13. ADC 1st order IIR Filter Coefficients Filter FIlter Coefficient First Order IIR 26 TLV320AIC3206 Application ADC Coefficient Left Channel ADC Coefficient Right Channel N0 C4 (Pg 8,Reg 24,25,26) C36 (Pg 9,Reg 32,33,34) N1 C5 (Pg 8,Reg 28,29,30) C37 (Pg 9,Reg 36,37,38) D1 C6 (Pg 8,Reg 32,33,34) C39 (Pg 9,Reg 40,41,42) SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated ADC www.ti.com 2.3.3.1.10.2 Biquad Section The transfer function of each of the Biquad Filters is given by H( z ) = N0 + 2 * N1z -1 + N2 z -2 2 23 - 2 * D1z -1 - D 2 z -2 (4) The frequency response for each of the biquad section with default coefficients is flat at a gain of 0dB. Details on ADC coefficient default values are given in Section 5.11. Table 2-14. ADC Biquad Filter Coefficients Filter FIlter Coefficient BIQUAD A BIQUAD B BIQUAD C BIQUAD D BIQUAD E ADC Coefficient Left Channel ADC Coefficient Right Channel N0 C7 (Pg 8, Reg 36,37,38) C39 (Pg 9, Reg 44,45,46) N1 C8 (Pg 8, Reg 40,41,42) C40 (Pg 9, Reg 48,49,50) N2 C9 (Pg 8, Reg 44,45,46) C41 (Pg 9, Reg 52,53,54) D1 C10 (Pg 8, Reg 48,49,50) C42 (Pg 9, Reg 56,57,58) D2 C11 (Pg 8, Reg 52,53,54) C43 (Pg 9, Reg 60,61,62) N0 C12 (Pg 8, Reg 56,57,58) C44 (Pg 9, Reg 64,65,66) N1 C13 (Pg 8, Reg 60,61,62) C45 (Pg 9, Reg 68,69,70) N2 C14 (Pg 8, Reg 64,65,66) C46 (Pg 9, Reg 72,73,74) D1 C15 (Pg 8, Reg 68,69,70) C47 (Pg 9, Reg 76,77,78) D2 C16 (Pg 8, Reg 72,73,74) C48 (Pg 9, Reg 80,81,82) N0 C17 (Pg 8, Reg 76,77,78) C49 (Pg 9, Reg 84,85,86) N1 C18 (Pg 8, Reg 80,81,82) C50 (Pg 9, Reg 88,89,90) N2 C19 (Pg 8, Reg 84,85,86) C51 (Pg 9, Reg 92,93,94) D1 C20 (Pg 8, Reg 88,89,90) C52 (Pg 9, Reg 96,97,98) D2 C21 (Pg 8, Reg 92,93,94) C53 (Pg 9, Reg 100,101,102) N0 C22 (Pg 8, Reg 96,97,98) C54 (Pg 9, Reg 104,105,106) N1 C23 (Pg 8, Reg 100,101,102) C55 (Pg 9, Reg 108,109,110) N2 C24 (Pg 8, Reg 104,105,106) C56 (Pg 9, Reg 112,113,114) D1 C25 (Pg 8, Reg 108,109,110) C57 (Pg 9, Reg 116,117,118) D2 C26 (Pg 8, Reg 112,113,114) C58 (Pg 9, Reg 120,121,122) N0 C27 (Pg 8, Reg 116,117,118) C59 (Pg 9, Reg 124,125,126) N1 C28 (Pg 8, Reg 120,121,122) C60 (Pg 10, Reg 8,9,10) N2 C29 (Pg 8, Reg 124,125,126) C61 (Pg 10, Reg 12,13,14) D1 C30 (Pg 9, Reg 8,9,10) C62 (Pg 10, Reg 16,17,18) D2 C31 (Pg 9, Reg 12,13,14) C63 (Pg 10, Reg 20,21,22) SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated TLV320AIC3206 Application 27 ADC www.ti.com 2.3.3.1.10.3 FIR Section Six of the available ADC processing blocks offer FIR filters for signal processing. PRB_R9 and PRB_R12 feature a 20-tap FIR filter while the processing blocks PRB_R3, PRB_R6, PRB_R15 and PRB_R18 feature a 25-tap FIR filter. M H( z ) = å Firn z -n n =0 M = 24, for PRB_R3, PRB_R6, PRB_R15 and PRB_R18 M = 19, for PRB_R9 and PRB_R12 (5) The coefficients of the FIR filters are 24-bit 2’s complement format and correspond to the ADC coefficient space as listed below. There is no default transfer function for the FIR filter. When the FIR filter gets used all applicable coefficients must be programmed. Table 2-15. ADC FIR Filter Coefficients 28 Filter FIlter Coefficient Left ADC Channel Filter Coefficient Right ADC Channel Fir0 C7 (Pg 8, Reg 36,37,38) C39 (Pg 9, Reg 44,45,46) Fir1 C8 (Pg 8, Reg 40,41,42) C40 (Pg 9, Reg 48,49,50) Fir2 C9 (Pg 8, Reg 44,45,46) C41 (Pg 9, Reg 52,53,54) Fir3 C10 (Pg 8, Reg 48,49,50) C42 (Pg 9, Reg 56,57,58) Fir4 C11 (Pg 8, Reg 52,53,54) C43 (Pg 9, Reg 60,61,62) Fir5 C12 (Pg 8, Reg 56,57,58) C44 (Pg 9, Reg 64,65,66) Fir6 C13 (Pg 8, Reg 60,61,62) C45 (Pg 9, Reg 68,69,70) Fir7 C14 (Pg 8, Reg 64,65,66) C46 (Pg 9, Reg 72,73,74) Fir8 C15 (Pg 8, Reg 68,69,70) C47 (Pg 9, Reg 76,77,78) Fir9 C16 (Pg 8, Reg 72,73,74) C48 (Pg 9, Reg 80,81,82) Fir10 C17 (Pg 8, Reg 76,77,78) C49 (Pg 9, Reg 84,85,86) Fir11 C18 (Pg 8, Reg 80,81,82) C50 (Pg 9, Reg 88,89,90) Fir12 C19 (Pg 8, Reg 84,85,86) C51 (Pg 9, Reg 92,93,94) Fir13 C20 (Pg 8, Reg 88,89,90) C52 (Pg 9, Reg 96,97,98) Fir14 C21 (Pg 8, Reg 92,93,94) C53 (Pg 9, Reg 100,101,102) Fir15 C22 (Pg 8, Reg 96,97,98) C54 (Pg 9, Reg 104,105,106) Fir16 C23 (Pg 8, Reg 100,101,102) C55 (Pg 9, Reg 108,109,110) Fir17 C24 (Pg 8, Reg 104,105,106) C56 (Pg 9, Reg 112,113,114) Fir18 C25 (Pg 8, Reg 108,109,110) C57 (Pg 9, Reg 116,117,118) Fir19 C26 (Pg 8, Reg 112,113,114) C58 (Pg 9, Reg 120,121,122) Fir20 C27 (Pg 8, Reg 116,117,118) C59 (Pg 9, Reg 124,125,126) Fir21 C28 (Pg 8, Reg 120,121,122) C60 (Pg 10, Reg 8,9,10) Fir22 C29 (Pg 8, Reg 124,125,126) C61 (Pg 10, Reg 12,13,14) Fir23 C30 (Pg 9, Reg 8,9,10) C62 (Pg 10, Reg 16,17,18) Fir24 C31 (Pg 9, Reg 12,13,14) C63 (Pg 10, Reg 20,21,22) TLV320AIC3206 Application SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated ADC www.ti.com 2.3.3.1.11 Decimation Filter The TLV320AIC3206 offers 3 different types of decimation filters. The integrated digital decimation filter removes high-frequency content and down samples the audio data from an initial sampling rate of AOSR * fS to the final output sampling rate of fS. The decimation filtering is achieved using a higher-order CIC filter followed by linear-phase FIR filters. The decimation filter cannot be chosen by itself, it is implicitly set through the chosen processing block. The following subsections describe the properties of the available filters A, B and C. 2.3.3.1.11.1 Decimation Filter A This filter is intended for use at sampling rates up to 48kHz. When configuring this filter, the oversampling ratio of the ADC can either be 128 or 64. For highest performance the oversampling ratio must be set to 128. Please also see the PowerTune chapter for details on performance and power in dependency of AOSR. Filter A can also be used for 96kHz at an AOSR of 64. Table 2-16. ADC Decimation Filter A, Specification Parameter Condition Value (Typical) Units Filter Gain Pass Band 0…0.39fS 0.062 dB Filter Gain Stop Band 0.55…64fS –73 dB 17 / fS Sec. AOSR = 128 Filter Group Delay Pass Band Ripple, 8 ksps 0…0.39fS 0.062 dB Pass Band Ripple, 44.1 ksps 0…0.39fS 0.05 dB Pass Band Ripple, 48 ksps 0…0.39fS 0.05 dB Filter Gain Pass Band 0…0.39fS 0.062 dB Filter Gain Stop Band 0.55…32fS –73 dB 17 / fS Sec. AOSR = 64 Filter Group Delay Pass Band Ripple, 8 ksps 0…0.39fS 0.062 dB Pass Band Ripple, 44.1 ksps 0…0.39fS 0.05 dB Pass Band Ripple, 48 ksps 0…0.39fS 0.05 dB Pass Band Ripple, 96 ksps 0…20kHz 0.1 dB ADC Channel Response for Decimation Filter A (Red line corresponds to –73 dB) 0 –10 –20 Magnitude – dB –30 –40 –50 –60 –70 –80 –90 –100 0.0 0.2 0.4 0.6 0.8 1.0 1.2 1.4 1.6 1.8 2.0 Frequency Normalized to fS G013 Figure 2-18. ADC Decimation Filter A, Frequency Response SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated TLV320AIC3206 Application 29 ADC www.ti.com 2.3.3.1.11.2 Decimation Filter B Filter B is intended to support sampling rates up to 96kHz at a oversampling ratio of 64. Table 2-17. ADC Decimation Filter B, Specifications Parameter Condition Value (Typical) Units Filter Gain Pass Band 0…0.39fS ±0.077 dB Filter Gain Stop Band 0.60…32fS –46 dB AOSR = 64 Filter Group Delay 11 / fS Sec. Pass Band Ripple, 8 ksps 0…0.39fS 0.076 dB Pass Band Ripple, 44.1 ksps 0…0.39fS 0.06 dB Pass Band Ripple, 48 ksps 0…0.39fS 0.06 dB Pass Band Ripple, 96 ksps 0…20kHz 0.11 dB ADC Channel Response for Decimation Filter B (Red line corresponds to –44 dB) 0 –10 Magnitude – dB –20 –30 –40 –50 –60 –70 –80 –90 0.0 0.2 0.4 0.6 0.8 1.0 1.2 1.4 1.6 1.8 2.0 Frequency Normalized to fS G014 Figure 2-19. ADC Decimation Filter B, Frequency Response 30 TLV320AIC3206 Application SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated ADC www.ti.com 2.3.3.1.11.3 Decimation Filter C Filter type C along with AOSR of 32 is specially designed for 192ksps operation for the ADC. The pass band which extends up to 0.11 * fS ( corresponds to 21kHz), is suited for audio applications. Table 2-18. ADC Decimation Filter C, Specifications Parameter Condition Value (Typical) Units Filter Gain from 0 to 0.11fS 0…0.11fS ±0.033 dB Filter Gain from 0.28 to 16fS 0.28…16fS –60 dB 11 / fS Sec. Filter Group Delay Pass Band Ripple, 8 ksps 0…0.11fS 0.033 dB Pass Band Ripple, 44.1 ksps 0…0.11fS 0.033 dB Pass Band Ripple, 48 ksps 0…0.11fS 0.032 dB Pass Band Ripple, 96 ksps 0…0.11fS 0.032 dB Pass Band Ripple, 192 ksps 0…20kHz 0.086 dB ADC Channel Response for Decimation Filter C (Red line corresponds to –60 dB) 0 Magnitude – dB –20 –40 –60 –80 –100 –120 0.0 0.2 0.4 0.6 0.8 1.0 1.2 1.4 1.6 1.8 2.0 Frequency Normalized to fS G015 Figure 2-20. ADC Decimation Filter C, Frequency Response 2.3.3.1.12 ADC Data Interface The decimation filter and signal processing block in the ADC channel passes 32-bit data words to the audio serial interface once every cycle of fS,ADC. During each cycle of fS,ADC, a pair of data words (for left and right channel) are passed. The audio serial interface rounds the data to the required word length of the interface before converting to serial data as per the different modes for audio serial interface. SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated TLV320AIC3206 Application 31 ADC www.ti.com 2.3.3.2 ADC Special Functions 2.3.3.2.1 Microphone Bias The built-in low noise Microphone Bias amplifier for electret-condenser microphones supports up to 3mA of load current to support multiple microphones. The bias amplifier provides a combination of high PSRR, low noise and programmable bias voltages to allow the user to fine tune the biasing to specific microphone combinations. The bias amplifier operates from AVDD. Table 2-19. MICBIAS Voltage Control Page 1, Reg 51, D(5:4) Page 1, Reg 10, D6 Page 1, Reg 51, D(3) MICBIAS Voltage (without load) 00 0 X 1.25V 00 1 X 1.0V 01 0 X 1.7V 01 1 X 1.4V 10 0 1 2.5V 10 1 1 2.1V 11 X 0 AVdd 2.3.3.2.2 Digital Microphone Function In addition to supporting analog microphones, the TLV320AIC3206 also interfaces to digital microphones. Σ-Δ DIG_MIC_IN LEFT ADC CIC FILTER Signal Processing Blocks Σ-Δ RIGHT ADC CIC FILTER ADC_MOD_CLK MISO GPIO DIN SCLK Figure 2-21. Digital Microphone in TLV320AIC3206 The TLV320AIC3206 outputs internal clock ADC_MOD_CLK on GPIO pin (Page 0, Register 51, D(5:2)) or MISO pin (Page 0, Register 55, D(4:1)). This clock can be connected to the external digital microphone device. The single-bit output of the external digital microphone device can be connected to GPIO, DIN or SCLK pins. Internally the TLV320AIC3206 latches the steady value of data on the rising edge of ADC_MOD_CLK for the Left ADC channel, and the steady value of data on falling edge for the Right ADC channel. 32 TLV320AIC3206 Application SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated ADC www.ti.com ADC_MOD_CLK DIG_MIC_IN LEFT RIGHT LEFT RIGHT LEFT RIGHT Figure 2-22. Timing Diagram for Digital Microphone Interface The digital-microphone mode can be selectively enabled for only-left, only-right, or stereo channels. When the digital microphone mode is enabled, the analog section of the ADC can be powered down and bypassed for power efficiency. The AOSR value for the ADC channel must be configured to select the desired decimation ratio to be achieved based on the external digital microphone properties. Figure 2-23. Typical Digital Microphone External Circuitry SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated TLV320AIC3206 Application 33 ADC www.ti.com 2.3.3.2.3 Channel-to-Channel Phase Adjustment The TLV320AIC3206 has a built-in feature to fine-adjust the phase between the stereo ADC record signals. The phase compensation is particularly helpful in applications such as adjusting delays when using dual microphones for noise cancellation. This delay is controlled in fine amounts in the following fashion. Delay(7:0) = Page 0, Register 85, D(7:0) Where RIGHT _ ADC _ PHASE _ COMP ( t ) = RIGHT _ ADC _ OUT( t - t pr ) (6) where t pr = (Delay( 4 : 0) + Delay(6 : 5) * AOSR * k f ) AOSR * ADC _ FS (7) Where kf is a function of the decimation filter: Decimation Filter Type kf A 0.25 B 0.5 C 1 and LEFT _ ADC _ PHASE _ COMP ( t ) = LEFT _ ADC _ OUT ( t - t pl ) (8) Where t pl = 34 Delay (7) AOSR * ADC _ FS TLV320AIC3206 Application (9) SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated ADC www.ti.com 2.3.3.2.4 DC Measurement The TLV320AIC3206 supports a highly flexible DC measurement feature using the high resolution oversampling and noise-shaping ADC. This mode can be used when the particular ADC channel is not used for the voice or audio-record function. This mode can be enabled by programming Page 0, Register 102, D(7:6). The converted data is 24-bits, using 2.22 numbering format. The value of the converted data for the left-channel ADC can be read back from Page 0, Register 104-106 and for the right-channel ADC from Page 0, Register 107-109. Before reading back the converted data, Page 0, Register 103, D(6) must be programmed to latch the converted data into the read-back register. After the converted data is read back, Page 0, Register 103, D(6) must be reset to 0 immediately. In DC measurement mode, two measurement methods are supported. Mode A In DC-measurement mode A, a variable-length averaging filter is used. The length of the averaging filter D, can be programmed from 1 to 20 by programming Page 0, Register 102, D(4:0). To choose mode A, Page 0, Register 102, D(5) must be programmed to 0. Mode B To choose mode B Page 0, Register 102, D(5) must be programmed to 1. In DC-measurement mode B, a first-order IIR filter is used. The coefficients of this filter are determined by D, Page 0, Register 102, D(4:0). The nature of the filter is given in the table below Table 2-20. DC Measurement Bandwidth Settings D: Page 0, Reg 102 , D(4:0) –3 dB BW (kHz) 1 688.44 –0.5 dB BW (kHz) 236.5 2 275.97 96.334 3 127.4 44.579 4 61.505 21.532 5 30.248 10.59 6 15.004 5.253 7 7.472 2.616 8 3.729 1.305 9 1.862 652 10 931 326 11 465 163 12 232.6 81.5 13 116.3 40.7 14 58.1 20.3 15 29.1 10.2 16 14.54 5.09 17 7.25 2.54 18 3.63 1.27 19 1.8 0.635 20 0.908 0.3165 SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated TLV320AIC3206 Application 35 ADC www.ti.com By programming Page 0, Reg 103, D(5) to ‘1’, the averaging filter is periodically reset after 2R number of ADC_MOD_CLK, where R is programmed in Page 0, Reg 103, D(4:0). When Page 0, Reg 103, D(5) is set to 1 then the value of D should be less than the value of R. When Page 0, Reg 103, D(5) is programmed as 0 the averaging filter is never reset. 2.3.3.2.5 Fast Charging AC Capacitors The value of the coupling capacitor must be so chosen that the high-pass filter formed by the coupling capacitor and the input impedance do not affect the signal content. At power-up, before proper recording can begin, this coupling capacitor must be charged up to the common-mode voltage. To enable quick charging, the TLV320AIC3206 has modes to speed up the charging of the coupling capacitor. These modes are controlled through Page 1, Register 71, D(5:0). 2.3.3.2.6 Anti Thump For normal voice or audio recording, the analog input pins of the TLV320AIC3206, must be AC-coupled to isolate the DC-common mode voltage of the driving circuit from the common-mode voltage of the TLV320AIC3206. When the analog inputs are not selected for any routing, the input pins are tri-stated and the voltage on the pins is undefined. When the unselected inputs are selected for any routing, the input pins must charge from the undefined voltage to the input common-mode voltage. This charging signal can cause audible artifacts. In order to avoid such artifacts the TLV320AIC3206 also incorporates anti-thump circuitry to allow connection of unused inputs to the common-mode level. This feature is disabled by default, and can be enabled by writing the appropriate value into Page 1, Register 58, D(7:2). The use of this feature in combination with the PTM_R1 setting in Page 0, Register 61 when the ADC channel is powered down causes the additional current consumption of 700μA from AVdd and 125μA from DVdd in the sleep mode. 36 TLV320AIC3206 Application SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated ADC www.ti.com 2.3.3.2.7 Adaptive Filtering After the ADC is running, the filter coefficients are locked and cannot be accessed for read or write. However the TLV320AIC3206 offers an adaptive filter mode as well. Setting Register Page 8,Reg 1, D(2) = 1 turns on double buffering of the coefficients. In this mode filter coefficients can be updated through the host and activated without stopping and restarting the ADC, enabling advanced adaptive filtering applications. To support double buffering, all coefficients are stored in two buffers (Buffer A and B). When the ADC is running and adaptive filtering mode is turned on, setting the control bit Page 8, Reg 1,D(0) = 1 switches the coefficient buffers at the next start of a sampling period. The bit reverts to 0 after the switch occurs. At the same time, the flag Page 8, Reg 1, D(1) toggles. The flag in Page 8, Reg 1, D(1) indicates which of the two buffers is actually in use. Page 8, Reg 1, D(1) = 0: Buffer A is in use by the ADC engine, D(1) = 1: Buffer B is in use. While the device is running, coefficient updates are always made to the buffer not in use by the ADC, regardless to which buffer the coefficients have been written ADC running Flag, Page 8, Reg 1, D(1) Coefficient Buffer in use Writing to Will update No 0 None C4, Buffer A C4, Buffer A No 0 None C4, Buffer B C4, Buffer B Yes 0 Buffer A C4, Buffer A C4, Buffer B Yes 0 Buffer A C4, Buffer B C4, Buffer B Yes 1 Buffer B C4, Buffer A C4, Buffer A Yes 1 Buffer B C4, Buffer B C4, Buffer A SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated TLV320AIC3206 Application 37 ADC www.ti.com 2.3.3.3 ADC Setup The following discussion is intended to guide a system designer through the steps necessary to configure the TLV320AIC3206 ADC. Step 1 The system clock source (master clock) and the targeted ADC sampling frequency must be identified. The oversampling ratio (OSR) of the TLV320AIC3206 must be configured to match the properties of the digital microphone. Based on the identified filter type and the required signal processing capabilities the appropriate processing block can be determined from the list of available processing blocks (PRB_R1 to PRB_R18) (See Table 2-12). Based on the available master clock, the chosen OSR and the targeted sampling rate, the clock divider values NADC and MADC can be determined. If necessary the internal PLL will add a large degree of flexibility. In summary, Codec_Clkin which is either derived directly from the system clock source or from the internal PLL, divided by MADC, NADC and AOSR, must be equal to the ADC sampling rate ADC_or fS. The codec_clkin clock signal is shared with the DAC clock generation block. CODEC_CLKIN = NADC * MADC * AOSR * ADC_FS To a large degree NADC and MADC can be chosen independently in the range of 1 to 128. In general NADC should be as large as possible as long as the following condition can still be met: MADC * AOSR / 32 ≥ RC RC is a function of the chosen processing block, and is listed in Table 2-12. The common mode setting of the device is determined by the available analog power supply and the desired PowerTune mode; this common mode setting is shared across ADC, DAC (input common mode) and analog bypass path. At this point the following device specific parameters are known: PRB_Rx, AOSR, NADC, MADC, common mode setting Additionally if the PLL is used the PLL parameters P, J, D and R are determined as well. Step 2 Setting up the device via register programming: The following list gives a sequence of items that must be executed between powering up the device and reading data from the device: Define starting point: Set register page to 0 Initiate SW Reset Program Clock Settings Program PLL clock dividers P,J,D,R (if PLL is necessary) Power up PLL (if PLL is necessary) Program and power up NADC Program and power up MADC Program OSR value Program the processing block to be used At this point, at the latest, the analog power supply must be applied to the device 38 TLV320AIC3206 Application SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated DAC www.ti.com Program Analog Blocks Set register Page to 1 Disable coarse AVdd generation Enable Master Analog Power Control Program Common Mode voltage Program PowerTune (PTM) mode Program MicPGA startup delay Program Reference fast charging Routing of inputs and common mode to ADC input Unmute analog PGAs and set analog gain Power Up ADC Set register Page to 0 Power up ADC Channels Unmute digital volume control A detailed example can be found in Chapter 4. 2.4 DAC The TLV320AIC3206 includes a stereo audio DAC supporting data rates from 8kHz to 192kHz. Each channel of the stereo audio DAC consists of a signal-processing engine with fixed processing blocks, a digital interpolation filter, multi-bit digital delta-sigma modulator, and an analog reconstruction filter. The DAC is designed to provide enhanced performance at low sampling rates through increased oversampling and image filtering, thereby keeping quantization noise generated within the delta-sigma modulator and signal images strongly suppressed within the audio band to beyond 20kHz. To handle multiple input rates and optimize power dissipation and performance, the TLV320AIC3206 allows the system designer to program the oversampling rates over a wide range from 1 to 1024. The system designer can choose higher oversampling ratios for lower input data rates and lower oversampling ratios for higher input data rates. The TLV320AIC3206 DAC channel includes a built-in digital interpolation filter to generate oversampled data for the sigma-delta modulator. The interpolation filter can be chosen from three different types depending on required frequency response, group delay and sampling rate. The DAC path of the TLV320AIC3206 features many options for signal conditioning and signal routing: • 2 headphone amplifiers – Ground-centered, bipolar operation or unipolar operation – Usable in single-ended or differential mode – Analog volume setting with a range of -6 to +14dB • 2 line-out amplifiers – Usable in single-ended or differential mode – Analog volume setting with a range of -6 to +29dB • Digital volume control with a range of -63.5 to +24dB • Mute function • Dynamic range compression (DRC) In addition to the standard set of DAC features the TLV320AIC3206 also offers the following special features: • Built in sine wave generation (beep generator) • Digital auto mute • Adaptive filter mode The TLV320AIC3206 implements signal processing capabilities and interpolation filtering via processing blocks. These fixed processing blocks give users the choice of how much and what type of signal processing they may use and which interpolation filter is applied. SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated TLV320AIC3206 Application 39 DAC www.ti.com The choice between these processing blocks is part of the PowerTune strategy balancing power conservation and signal processing flexibility. Less signal processing capability will result in less power consumed by the device. Table 2-21 gives an overview over all available processing blocks of the DAC channel and their properties. The Resource Class Column (RC) gives an approximate indication of power consumption. The signal processing blocks available are: • First-order IIR • Scalable number of biquad filters • 3D – Effect • Beep Generator The processing blocks are tuned for typical cases and can achieve high image rejection or low group delay in combination with various signal processing effects such as audio effects and frequency shaping. The available first-order IIR and biquad filters have fully user-programmable coefficients. The Resource Class Column (RC) gives an approximate indication of power consumption. Table 2-21. Overview – DAC Predefined Processing Blocks (1) 40 Processing Block No. Interpolation Filter Channel 1st Order IIR Available Num. of Biquads DRC 3D Beep Generator PRB_P1 (1) A PRB_P2 A Stereo No Stereo Yes PRB_P3 PRB_P4 A Stereo A Left PRB_P5 A PRB_P6 PRB_P7 Resource Class 3 No No No 8 6 Yes No No 12 Yes 6 No No No 10 No 3 No No No 4 Left Yes 6 Yes No No 6 A Left Yes 6 No No No 6 B Stereo Yes 0 No No No 6 PRB_P8 B Stereo No 4 Yes No No 8 PRB_P9 B Stereo No 4 No No No 8 PRB_P10 B Stereo Yes 6 Yes No No 10 PRB_P11 B Stereo Yes 6 No No No 8 PRB_P12 B Left Yes 0 No No No 3 PRB_P13 B Left No 4 Yes No No 4 PRB_P14 B Left No 4 No No No 4 PRB_P15 B Left Yes 6 Yes No No 6 PRB_P16 B Left Yes 6 No No No 4 PRB_P17 C Stereo Yes 0 No No No 3 PRB_P18 C Stereo Yes 4 Yes No No 6 PRB_P19 C Stereo Yes 4 No No No 4 PRB_P20 C Left Yes 0 No No No 2 PRB_P21 C Left Yes 4 Yes No No 3 PRB_P22 C Left Yes 4 No No No 2 PRB_P23 A Stereo No 2 No Yes No 8 PRB_P24 A Stereo Yes 5 Yes Yes No 12 PRB_P25 A Stereo Yes 5 Yes Yes Yes 12 Default TLV320AIC3206 Application SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated DAC www.ti.com 2.4.1 Processing Blocks – Details 2.4.1.1 3 Biquads, Interpolation Filter A from interface BiQuad A BiQuad B BiQuad C Interp. Filter A * to modulator Digital Volume Ctrl Figure 2-24. Signal Chain for PRB_P1 and PRB_P4 2.4.1.2 6 Biquads, 1st order IIR, DRC, Interpolation Filter A or B IIR from interface BiQuad A BiQuad B BiQuad C BiQuad D BiQuad E BiQuad F HPF Interp. Filter A or B * to modulator Digital Volume Ctrl DRC Figure 2-25. Signal Chain for PRB_P2, PRB_P5, PRB_P10 and PRB_P15 2.4.1.3 6 Biquads, 1st order IIR, Interpolation Filter A or B IIR BiQuad A BiQuad B BiQuad C BiQuad D BiQuad E BiQuad F Interp. Filter A or B * to modulator Digital Volume Ctrl Figure 2-26. Signal Chain for PRB_P3, PRB_P6, PRB_P11 and PRB_P16 2.4.1.4 IIR, Interpolation Filter B or C IIR from interface Interp. Filter B or C * to modulator Digital Volume Ctrl Figure 2-27. Signal Chain for PRB_P7, PRB_P12, PRB_P17 and PRB_P20 SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated TLV320AIC3206 Application 41 DAC www.ti.com 2.4.1.5 4 Biquads, DRC, Interpolation Filter B from interface BiQuad A BiQuad B BiQuad C BiQuad D Interp. Filter B HPF * to modulator Digital Volume Ctrl DRC Figure 2-28. Signal Chain for PRB_P8 and PRB_P13 2.4.1.6 4 Biquads, Interpolation Filter B from interface BiQuad A BiQuad B BiQuad C BiQuad D Interp. Filter B * to modulator Digital Volume Ctrl Figure 2-29. Signal Chain for PRB_P9 and PRB_P14 2.4.1.7 4 Biquads, 1st order IIR, DRC, Interpolation Filter C BiQuad A IIR BiQuad B BiQuad C BiQuad D HPF Interp. Filter C from interface * to modulator Digital Volume Ctrl DRC Figure 2-30. Signal Chain for PRB_P18 and PRB_P21 2.4.1.8 4 Biquads, 1st order IIR, Interpolation Filter C IIR from interface BiQuad A BiQuad B BiQuad C BiQuad D Interp. Filter C * to modulator Digital Volume Ctrl Figure 2-31. Signal Chain for PRB_P19 and PRB_P22 42 TLV320AIC3206 Application SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated DAC www.ti.com 2.4.1.9 2 Biquads, 3D, Interpolation Filter A from left channel interface + + + IIR left + - from right channel interface BiQuad CL Interp. Filter A * to modulator Digital Volume Ctrl BiQuad AL + - IIR right BiQuad BL + + BiQuad AR BiQuad BR 3D PGA BiQuad CR Interp. Filter A * to modulator Digital Volume Ctrl Figure 2-32. Signal Chain for PRB_P23 2.4.1.10 5 Biquads, DRC, 3D, Interpolation Filter A from left channel interface IIR left + + BiQuad BL BiQuad CL BiQuad DL BiQuad EL BiQuad FL HPF Interp. Filter A * to modulator + Digital Volume Ctrl DRC + BiQuad AL + - BiQuad AR 3D PGA - from right channel interface IIR right + + BiQuad BR BiQuad CR BiQuad DR BiQuad ER BiQuad FR HPF Interp. Filter A DRC * to modulator Digital Volume Ctrl Figure 2-33. Signal Chain for PRB_P24 SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated TLV320AIC3206 Application 43 DAC www.ti.com 2.4.1.11 5 Biquads, DRC, 3D, Beep Generator, Interpolation Filter A from left channel interface IIR left + BiQuad BL + BiQuad CL BiQuad DL BiQuad EL BiQuad FL HPF Interp. Filter A + * to modulator + DRC + BiQuad AL + - BiQuad AR 3D PGA Digital Volume Ctrl * Beep Gen. Beep Volume Ctrl * from right channel interface IIR right + BiQuad BR + BiQuad CR BiQuad DR BiQuad ER BiQuad FR HPF Interp. Filter A DRC * + to modulator Digital Volume Ctrl Figure 2-34. Signal Chain for PRB_P25 2.4.2 User Programmable Filters Depending on the selected processing block, different types and orders of digital filtering are available. Up to 6 biquad sections are available for specific processing blocks. The coefficients of the available filters are arranged as sequentially-indexed coefficients in two banks. If adaptive filtering is chosen, the coefficient banks can be switched on-the-fly. For more details on adaptive filtering please see Section 2.4.5.3. The coefficients of these filters are each 24-bits wide, in two's-complement and occupy 3 consecutive 8-bit registers in the register space. For default values please see the default values tables in the Register Map section. 2.4.2.1 First Order IIR Section The IIR is of first-order and its transfer function is given by H( z) = N0 + N1z -1 2 23 - D1z -1 (10) The frequency response for the first order IIR Section with default coefficients is flat. Details on DAC coefficient default values are given in Section 5.13. Table 2-22. DAC IIR Filter Coefficients Filter First order IIR 44 TLV320AIC3206 Application Filter Coefficient ADC Coefficient Left Channel ADC Coefficient Right Channel N0 C65 (Page 46, Registers 28,29,30) C68 (Page 46, Registers 40,41,42) N1 C66 (Page 46, Registers 32,33,34) C69 (Page 46, Registers 44,45,46) D1 C67 (Page 46, Registers 36,37,38) V70 (Page 46, Registers 48,49,50) SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated DAC www.ti.com 2.4.2.2 Biquad Section The transfer function of each of the Biquad Filters is given by H( z ) = N0 + 2 * N1z -1 + N2 z -2 2 23 - 2 * D1z -1 - D 2 z -2 (11) The frequency response for each biquad section with default coefficients is flat at a gain of 0dB. Details on DAC coefficient default values are given in Section 5.13. Table 2-23. DAC Biquad Filter Coefficients Filter BIQUAD A BIQUAD B BIQUAD C BIQUAD D BIQUAD E BIQUAD F Coefficient Left DAC Channel Right DAC Channel N0 C1 (Page 44, Registers 12,13,14) C33 (Page 45, Registers 20,21,22) N1 C2 (Page 44, Registers 16,17,18) C34 (Page 45, Registers 24,25,26) N2 C3 (Page 44, Registers 20,21,22) C35 (Page 45, Registers 28,29,30) D1 C4 (Page 44, Registers 24,25,26) C36 (Page 45, Registers 32,33,34) D2 C5 (Page 44, Registers 28,29,30) C37 (Page 45, Registers 36,37,38) N0 C6 (Page 44, Registers 32,33,34) C38 (Page 45, Registers 40,41,42) N1 C7 (Page 44, Registers 36,37,38) C39 (Page 45, Registers 44,45,46) N2 C8 (Page 44, Registers 40,41,42) C40 (Page 45, Registers 48,49,50) D1 C9 (Page 44, Registers 44,45,46) C41 (Page 45, Registers 52,53,54) D2 C10 (Page 44, Registers 48,49,50) C42 (Page 45, Registers 56,57,58) N0 C11 (Page 44, Registers 52,53,54) C43 (Page 45, Registers 60,61,62) N1 C12 (Page 44, Registers 56,57,58) C44 (Page 45, Registers 64,65,66) N2 C13 (Page 44, Registers 60,61,62) C45 (Page 45, Registers 68,69,70) D1 C14 (Page 44, Registers 64,65,66) C46 (Page 45, Registers 72,73,74) D2 C15 (Page 44, Registers 68,69,70) C47 (Page 45, Registers 76,77,78) N0 C16 (Page 44, Registers 72,73,74) C48 (Page 45, Registers 80,81,82) N1 C17 (Page 44, Registers 76,77,78) C49 (Page 45, Registers 84,85,86) N2 C18 (Page 44, Registers 80,81,82) C50 (Page 45, Registers 88,89,90) D1 C19 (Page 44, Registers 84,85,86) C51 (Page 45, Registers 92,93,94) D2 C20 (Page 44, Registers 88,89,90) C52 (Page 45, Registers 96,97,98) N0 C21 (Page 44, Registers 92,93,94) C53 (Page 45, Registers 100,101,102) N1 C22 (Page 44, Registers 96,97,98) C54 (Page 45, Registers 104,105,106) N2 C23 (Page 44, Registers 100,101,102) C55 (Page 45, Registers 108,109,110) D1 C24 (Page 44, Registers 104,105,106) C56 (Page 45, Registers 112,113,114) D2 C25 (Page 44, Registers 108,109,110) C57 (Page 45, Registers 116,117,118) N0 C26 (Page 44, Registers 112,113,114) C58 (Page 45, Registers 120,121,122) N1 C27 (Page 44, Registers 116,117,118) C59 (Page 45, Registers 124,125,126) N2 C28 (Page 44, Registers 120,121,122) C60 (Page 46, Registers 8,9,10) D1 C29 (Page 44, Registers 124,125,126) C61 (Page 46, Registers 12,13,14) D2 C30 (Page 45, Registers 8,9,10) C62 (Page 46, Registers 16,17,18) 2.4.2.2.1 3D-PGA The 3D-PGA attenuation block as used in the processing blocks PRB_P23, PRB_P24 and PRB_P25 can be programmed in the range of -1.0 to +1.0. A value of -1.0 corresponds to 0x7FFFFF in DAC coefficient C32 (Page 45, Register 16,17 and 18). A value of 1.0 corresponds to 0x800000 in coefficient C32. SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated TLV320AIC3206 Application 45 DAC www.ti.com 2.4.3 Interpolation Filters 2.4.3.1 Interpolation Filter A Filter A is designed for an fS up to 48ksps with a flat passband of 0kHz–20kHz. Table 2-24. DAC Interpolation Filter A, Specification Parameter Condition Value (Typical) Units Filter Gain Pass Band 0 … 0.45fS ±0.015 dB Filter Gain Stop Band 0.55… 7.455fS –65 dB 21 / fS s Filter Group Delay DAC Channel Response for Interpolation Filter A (Red line corresponds to –65 dB) 0 –10 Magnitude – dB –20 –30 –40 –50 –60 –70 –80 –90 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 Frequency Normalized to fS G016 Figure 2-35. DAC Interpolation Filter A, Frequency Response 2.4.3.2 Interpolation Filter B Filter B is specifically designed for an fS of above 96ksps. Thus, the flat pass-band region easily covers the required audio band of 0-20kHz. Table 2-25. DAC Interpolation Filter B, Specification Parameter Condition Value (Typical) Units Filter Gain Pass Band 0 … 0.45fS ±0.015 dB Filter Gain Stop Band 0.55… 3.45fS –58 dB 18 / fS s Filter Group Delay 46 TLV320AIC3206 Application SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated DAC www.ti.com DAC Channel Response for Interpolation Filter B (Red line corresponds to –58 dB) 0 –10 Magnitude – dB –20 –30 –40 –50 –60 –70 –80 0.5 1.0 1.5 2.0 2.5 3.0 3.5 Frequency Normalized to fS G017 Figure 2-36. Channel Interpolation Filter B, Frequency Response 2.4.3.3 Interpolation Filter C Filter C is specifically designed for the 192ksps mode. The pass band extends up to 0.40 * fS (corresponds to 80kHz), more than sufficient for audio applications. DAC Channel Response for Interpolation Filter C (Red line corresponds to –43 dB) 0 –10 Magnitude – dB –20 –30 –40 –50 –60 –70 0.0 0.2 0.4 0.6 0.8 1.0 1.2 1.4 Frequency Normalized to fS G018 Figure 2-37. DAC Interpolation Filter C, Frequency Response Table 2-26. DAC Interpolation Filter C, Specification Parameter Condition Value (Typical) Units Filter Gain Pass Band 0 … 0.35fS ±0.03 dB Filter Gain Stop Band 0.60… 1.4fS –43 dB 13 / fS s Filter Group Delay SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated TLV320AIC3206 Application 47 DAC www.ti.com 2.4.4 DAC Gain Setting 2.4.4.1 PowerTune Modes As part of the PowerTune strategy, the analog properties of the DAC are adjusted. As a consequence, the full-scale signal swing achieved at the headphone and line outputs must be adjusted. Please see Table 2-27 for the proper gain compensation values across the different combinations. Table 2-27. DAC Gain versus. PowerTune Modes DAC PowerTune Mode Control PowerTune Mode Page 1,Register 3 or 4, D(4:2) 2.4.4.2 Headphone or Line-out Gain CM = 0.75V, Gain for 375mVRMS output swing at 0dB full scale input CM = 0.9V, Gain for 500mVRMS output swing at 0dB full scale input 000 PTM_P3, PTM_P4 0 0 001 PTM_P2 4 4 010 PTM_P1 14 14 Digital Volume Control The TLV320AIC3206 signal processing blocks incorporate a digital volume control block that can control the volume of the playback signal from +24dB to –63.5dB in steps of 0.5dB. These can be controlled by writing to Page 0, Register 65 and 66. The volume control of left and right channels by default can be controlled independently, however by programming Page 0, Reg 64, D(1:0), they can be made interdependent. The volume changes are soft-stepped in steps of 0.5dB to avoid audible artifacts during gain change. The rate of soft-stepping can be controlled by programming Page 0, Reg 63, D(1:0) to either one step per frame (DAC_FS) or one step per 2 frames. The soft-stepping feature can also be entirely disabled. During soft-stepping the value of the actual applied gain would differ from the programmed gain in register. The TLV320AIC3206 gives a feedback to the user in form of register readable flag to indicate that soft-stepping is currently in progress. The flags for left and right channels can be read back by reading Page 0, Reg 38, Bits D4 and D0 respectively. A value of 0 in these flags indicates a soft-stepping operation in progress, and a value of 1 indicates that soft-stepping has completed. A soft-stepping operation comes into effect during (a) power-up, when the volume control soft-steps from –63.5dB to programmed gain value, (b) volume change by user when DAC is powered up, and (c) power-down, when the volume control block soft-steps to –63.5dB before powering down the channel. 2.4.4.3 Dynamic Range Compression Typical music signals are characterized by crest factors, the ratio of peak signal power to average signal power, of 12dB or more. To avoid audible distortion due to clipping of peak signals, the gain of the DAC channel must be adjusted to prevent hard clipping of peak signals. As a result, during nominal periods, the applied gain is low, causing the perception that the signal is not loud enough. To overcome this problem, the DRC in the TLV320AIC3206 continuously monitors the output of the DAC Digital Volume control to detect its power level w.r.t. 0dBFS. When the power level is low, it increases the input signal gain to make it sound louder. At the same time, if a peaking signal is detected, it autonomously reduces the applied gain to avoid hard clipping. The resulting sound can be more pleasing to the ear as well as sounding louder during nominal periods. The DRC functionality in the TLV320AIC3206 is implemented by a combination of Processing Blocks in the DAC channel as described in Section 2.4.1. The DRC can be disabled by writing into Page 0, Reg 68, D(6:5). The DRC typically works on the filtered version of the input signal. The input signals have no audio information at DC and extremely low frequencies; however they can significantly influence the energy estimation function in DRC. Also most of the information about signal energy is concentrated in the low frequency region of the input signal. 48 TLV320AIC3206 Application SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated DAC www.ti.com In order to estimate the energy of the input signal, the signal is first fed to the DRC high-pass filter and then to the DRC low-pass filter. These filters are implemented as first-order IIR filters given by HHPF ( z ) = HLPF ( z ) = N0 + N1z -1 2 23 - D1z -1 N0 + N1z (12) -1 2 23 - D1z -1 (13) The coefficients for these filters are 24-bits wide in two’s-complement and are user programmable through register write as given in Table 2-28, and coefficient default values are summarized in Section 5.13. Table 2-28. DRC HPF and LPF Coefficients Coefficient Location HPF N0 C71 Page 46, Register 52 to 55 HPF N1 C72 Page 46, Register 56 to 59 HPF D1 C73 Page 46, Register 60 to 63 LPF N0 C74 Page 46, Register 64 to 67 LPF N1 C75 Page 46, Register 68 to 71 LPF D1 C76 Page 46, Register 72 to 75 The default values of these coefficients implement a high-pass filter with a cut-off at 0.00166 * DAC_FS, and a low-pass filter with a cutoff at 0.00033 * DAC_FS. The output of the DRC high-pass filter is fed to the Processing Block selected for the DAC Channel. The absolute value of the DRC-LPF filter is used for energy estimation within the DRC. The gain in the DAC Digital Volume Control is controlled by Page 0, Register 65 and 66. When the DRC is enabled, the applied gain is a function of the Digital Volume Control register setting and the output of the DRC. The DRC parameters are described in sections that follow. 2.4.4.3.1 DRC Threshold The DRC Threshold represents the level of the DAC playback signal at which the gain compression becomes active. The output of the digital volume control in the DAC is compared with the set threshold. The threshold value is programmable by writing to register Page 0, Register 68, D(4:2). The Threshold value can be adjusted between –3dBFS to –24dBFS in steps of 3dB. Keeping the DRC Threshold value too high may not leave enough time for the DRC block to detect peaking signals, and can cause excessive distortion at the outputs. Keeping the DRC Threshold value too low can limit the perceived loudness of the output signal. The recommended DRC-Threshold value is –24dB. When the output signal exceeds the set DRC Threshold, the interrupt flag bits at Page 0, Register 44, D(3:2) are updated. These flag bits are 'sticky' in nature, and are reset only after they are read back by the user. The non-sticky versions of the interrupt flags are also available at Page 0, Register 46, D(3:2). 2.4.4.3.2 DRC Hysteresis DRC Hysteresis is programmable by writing to Page 0, Register 68, D(1:0) with values between 0dB and 3dB in steps of 1dB. DRC Hysteresis is a programmable window around the programmed DRC Threshold that must be exceeded for a disabled DRC to become enabled, or an enabled DRC to become disabled. For example, if the DRC Threshold is set to –12dBFS and DRC Hysteresis is set to 3dB, then if the gain compressions in the DRC is inactive, the output of the DAC Digital Volume Control must exceed –9dBFS before gain compression due to the DRC is activated. Similarly, when the gain compression in the DRC is SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated TLV320AIC3206 Application 49 DAC www.ti.com active, the output of the DAC Digital Volume Control must fall below –15dBFS for gain compression in the DRC to be deactivated. The DRC Hysteresis feature prevents the rapid activation and de-activation of gain compression in the DRC in cases when the output of DAC Digital Volume Control rapidly fluctuates in a narrow region around the programmed DRC Threshold. Programming the DRC Hysteresis as 0dB disables the hysteresis action. Recommended Value of DRC Hysteresis is 3dB. 2.4.4.3.3 DRC Hold The DRC Hold function slows the start of decay for a specified period of time in response to a decrease in energy level. To minimize audible artifacts, it is recommended to set the DRC Hold time to 0 through programming Page 0, Register 69, D(6:3) = 0000. 2.4.4.3.4 DRC Attack Rate When the output of the DAC Digital Volume Control exceeds the programmed DRC Threshold, the gain applied in the DAC Digital Volume Control is progressively reduced to avoid the signal from saturating the channel. This process of reducing the applied gain is called Attack. To avoid audible artifacts, the gain is reduced slowly with a rate equaling the Attack Rate programmable via Page 0, Register 70, D(7:4). Attack Rates can be programmed from 4dB gain change per sample period (1 / DAC_FS) to 1.2207e-5dB gain change per sample period. Attack Rates should be programmed such that before the output of the DAC Digital Volume control can clip, the input signal should be sufficiently attenuated. High Attack Rates can cause audible artifacts, and too-slow Attack Rates may not prevent the input signal from clipping. The recommended DRC Attack Rate value is 1.9531e-4 dB per sample period. 2.4.4.3.5 DRC Decay Rate When the DRC detects a reduction in output signal swing beyond the programmed DRC Threshold, the DRC enters a Decay state, where the applied gain in Digital Volume Control is gradually increased to programmed values. To avoid audible artifacts, the gain is slowly increased with a rate equal to the Decay Rate programmed through Page 0, Register 70, D(3:0). The Decay Rates can be programmed from 1.5625e-3dB per sample period to 4.7683e-7dB per sample period. If the Decay Rates are programmed too high, then sudden gain changes can cause audible artifacts. However, if it is programmed too slow, then the output may be perceived as too low for a long time after the peak signal has passed. The recommended Value of DRC Decay Rate is 2.4414e-5 dB per sample period. 2.4.4.3.6 • • • • • • Example Setup for DRC PGA Gain = 12dB Threshold = -24dB Hysteresis = 3dB Hold time = 0ms Attack Rate = 1.9531e-4 dB per sample period Decay Rate = 2.4414e-5 dB per sample period Script w w w w w w w w w 50 30 30 30 30 30 30 30 30 30 00 41 42 44 45 46 00 34 40 00 #Go to Page 0 18 #DAC => 12 db gain left 18 #DAC => 12 db gain right 7F #DAC => DRC Enabled for both channels, Threshold = -24 db, Hysteresis = 3 dB 00 #DRC Hold = 0 ms, Rate of Changes of Gain = 0.5 dB/Fs' B6 #Attack Rate = 1.9531e-4 dB/Frame , DRC Decay Rate =2.4414e-5 dB/Frame 2E #Go to Page 46 7F AB 00 00 80 55 00 00 7F 56 00 00 #DRC HPF 00 11 00 00 00 11 00 00 7F DE 00 00 #DRC LPF TLV320AIC3206 Application SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated DAC www.ti.com 2.4.5 DAC Special Functions 2.4.5.1 Beep Generation A special function has also been included in the processing block PRB_P25 for generating a digital sinewave signal that is sent to the DAC. This signal is intended for generating key-click sounds for user feedback. A default value for the sine-wave frequency, sine burst length, and signal magnitude is kept in the Tone Generator Registers Page 0, Registers 71 through 79. The sine wave generator is very flexible, and is completely register programmable via 9 registers of 8 bits each to provide many different sounds. Two registers are used for programming the 16-bit, two's-complement, sine-wave coefficient (Page 0, Registers 76 and 77). Two other registers program the 16-bit, two's-complement, cosine-wave coefficient (Page 0, Registers 78 and 79). This coefficient resolution allows virtually any frequency of sine wave in the audio band to be generated up to DAC_FS / 2. Three registers are used to control the length of the sine burst waveform which are located on Page 0, Registers 73, 74, and 75. The resolution (bit) in the registers of the sine burst length is one sample time, so this allows great control on the overall time of the sine burst waveform. This 24-bit length timer supports 16,777,215 sample times. (For example if DAC_FS is set at 48kHz, and the registers combined value equals 96000d (01770h), then the sine burst would last exactly two seconds.) Separate registers independently control the Left sine-wave volume and the Right sine-wave volume. The 6-bit digital volume control allows level control of 0dB to –63dB in one-dB steps. The left-channel volume is controlled by writing to Page 0, Register 71, D(5:0). The right-channel volume is controlled by Page 0, Register 72, D(5:0). A master volume control for the left and right channel of the beep generator can be set up using Page 0, Register 72, D(7:6). The default volume control setting is 0dB, the tone generator maximum-output level. To play back the sine wave, the DAC must be configured with regards to clock setup and routing. The sine wave starts by setting the Beep Generator Enable Bit (Page 1, Register 71, D(7) = 1). After the sine wave has played for its predefined time period this bit automatically resets back to 0. While the sine wave is playing, the parameters of the beep generator cannot be changed. To stop the sine wave before the predefined time period expires, set the Beep Generator Enable Bit to 0. 2.4.5.2 Digital Auto Mute The TLV320AIC3206 also incorporates a special feature where the DAC channel is auto-muted when a continuous stream of DC-input is detected. By default, this feature is disabled, and is enabled by writing a non-zero value into Page 0, Register 64, D(6:4). This non-zero value controls the duration of the continuous stream of DC-input before the auto-mute feature takes effect. This feature is especially helpful for eliminating high-frequency noise power from being delivered into the load during silent periods of speech or music. 2.4.5.3 Adaptive Filtering When the DAC is running, the user-programmable filter coefficients are locked and cannot be accessed for either read or write. However the TLV320AIC3206 offers an adaptive filter mode as well. Setting Register Page 44, Reg 1, Bit D(2) = 1 turns on double buffering of the coefficients. In this mode, filter coefficients can be updated through the host, and activated without stopping and restarting the DAC. This enables advanced adaptive filtering applications. In the double-buffering scheme, all coefficients are stored in two buffers (Buffers A and B). When the DAC is running and adaptive filtering mode is turned on, setting the control bit Page 44, Register 1, D(0) = 1 switches the coefficient buffers at the next start of a sampling period. This bit resets back to 0 after the switch occurs. At the same time, the flag (Page 44, Reg 1, D(1)) toggles. The flag in Page 44, Register 1, D(1) indicates which of the two buffers is actually in use. Page 44, Register 1, D(1) = 0: Buffer A is in use by the DAC engine, Bit D(1) = 1: Buffer B is in use. While the device is running, coefficient updates are always made to the buffer not in use by the DAC, regardless to which buffer the coefficients have been written. SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated TLV320AIC3206 Application 51 DAC www.ti.com DAC running Page 44, Reg 1, Bit D1 Coefficient Buffer in use Writing to Will update No 0 None C1, Buffer A C1, Buffer A No 0 None C1, Buffer B C1, Buffer B Yes 0 Buffer A C1, Buffer A C1, Buffer B Yes 0 Buffer A C1, Buffer B C1, Buffer B Yes 1 Buffer B C1, Buffer A C1, Buffer A Yes 1 Buffer B C1, Buffer B C1, Buffer A The user programmable coefficients C1 to C70 are defined on Pages 44, 45 and 46 for Buffer A and Pages 62, 63 and 64 for Buffer B. 2.4.6 DAC Setup This section lists the steps necessary to configure the TLV320AIC3206 DAC. Step 1 Determine the system clock source (master clock) and the targeted DAC sampling frequency. Choose the targeted performance. This drives the choice of the decimation filter type (A, B or C) and DOSR value. Use Filter A for 48kHz high-performance operation; DOSR must be a multiple of 8. Use Filter B for up to 96kHz operations; DOSR must be a multiple of 4. Use Filter C for up to 192kHz operations; DOSR must be a multiple of 2. In all cases the DOSR range is limited by the following condition: 2.8MHz < DOSR * DAC_FS < 6.2MHz Based on the identified filter type and the required signal processing capabilities, the appropriate processing block is determined from the list of available processing blocks (PRB_P1 to PRB_P25). Based on the available master clock, the chosen DOSR and the targeted sampling rate, the clock divider values NDAC and MDAC are calculated. If necessary, the internal PLL can add a large degree of flexibility. In summary, codec_clkin (derived directly from the system clock source or from the internal PLL) divided by MDAC, NDAC and DOSR must be equal to the DAC sampling rate DAC_FS. The codec_clkin clock signal is shared with the ADC clock generation block. CODEC_CLKIN = NDAC * MDAC * DOSR * DAC_FS To a large degree, NDAC and MDAC can be chosen independently in the range of 1 to 128. In general, NDAC should be as large as possible as long as the following condition can still be met: MDAC * DOSR / 32 ≥ RC RC is a function of the chosen processing block and is listed in Table 2-21. The common-mode voltage setting of the device is determined by the available analog power supply and the desired PowerTune mode. This common-mode (input common-mode) value is common across the ADC, DAC and analog bypass path. The output common-mode setting is determined by the available analog power supplies (AVDD and DRVdd_HP) and the desired output-signal swing. At this point the following device specific parameters are known: PRB_Px, DOSR, NDAC, MDAC, input and output common-mode values If the PLL is used, the PLL parameters P, J, D and R are determined as well. 52 TLV320AIC3206 Application SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated PowerTune www.ti.com Step 2 Setting up the device via register programming: The following list gives a sequence of items that must be executed in the time between powering the device up and reading data from the device: Define starting point: Set register page to 0 Initiate SW Reset Program Clock Settings Program PLL clock dividers P,J,D,R (if PLL is necessary) Power up PLL (if PLL is necessary) Program and power up NDAC Program and power up MDAC Program OSR value Program I2S word length if required (for example, 20bit) Program the processing block to be used At this point, at the latest, the analog power supply must be applied to the device Program Analog Blocks Set register Page to 1 Disable coarse AVDD generation Enable Master Analog Power Control Program Common Mode voltage Program PowerTune (PTM) mode Program Reference fast charging Program Headphone specific depop settings (in case of headphone driver used) Program routing of DAC output to the output amplifier (headphone or line out) Unmute and set gain of output driver Power up output driver Apply waiting time determined by the de-pop settings and the soft-stepping settings of the driver gain or poll Page 1 , Register 63 Power Up DAC Set register Page to 0 Power up DAC Channels Unmute digital volume control A detailed example can be found in the Example Setups section. 2.5 PowerTune The TLV320AIC3206 features PowerTune, a mechanism to balance power-versus-performance trade-offs at the time of device configuration. The device can be tuned to minimize power dissipation, to maximize performance, or to an operating point between the two extremes to best fit the application. 2.5.1 PowerTune Modes 2.5.1.1 ADC – Programming PTM_R1 to PTM_R4 The device powers up with PTM_R4 (highest performance) set as default. This mode always works across all combinations of common-mode voltage, chosen processing block, or chosen oversampling ratio. If the application can make use of a lower-power configuration please see the ADC and DAC power consumption chapters below for valid combination of PowerTune modes and other device parameters. The ADC configuration of the PowerTune mode affects right and left channels simultaneously. Pg 1, Reg 61, D(7:0) PTM_R1 PTM_R2 PTM_R3 PTM_R4 0xFF 0xB6 0x64 0x00 SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated TLV320AIC3206 Application 53 PowerTune 2.5.1.2 www.ti.com DAC - Programming PTM_P1 to PTM_P4 On the playback side, the performance is determined by a combination of register settings and the audio data word length applied. For the highest performance setting (PTM_P4), an audio-data word length of 20 bits is required, while for the modes PTM_P1 to PTM_P3 a word length of 16 bits is sufficient. 2.5.1.3 PTM_P1 PTM_P2 PTM_P3 PTM_P4 Pg 1, Reg 3, D(4:2) 0x2 0x1 0x0 0x0 Pg 1, Reg 4, D(4:2) 0x2 0x1 0x0 0x0 Audio Data word length 16 bits 16 bits 16 bits 20 or more bits Pg 0, Reg 27, D(5:4) 0x0 0x0 0x0 0x1, 0x2, 0x3 Processing Blocks The choice of processing blocks, PRB_P1 to PRB_P25 for playback and PRB_R1 to PRB_R18 for recording, also influences the power consumption. In fact, the numerous processing blocks have been implemented to offer a choice between power-optimization and configurations with more signal-processing resources. 2.5.2 ADC Power Consumption The tables in this section give recommendations for various PowerTune modes. Typical performance and power-consumption values are listed. PowerTune modes that are not supported are marked with an ‘X’. All measurements were taken with the PLL turned off and the ADC configured for single-ended input. The values given in the tables are intended as target-performance levels, not device specifications. For device specifications, see the TLV320AIC3206 data sheet, SLAS649. 54 TLV320AIC3206 Application SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated PowerTune www.ti.com 2.5.2.1 ADC, Stereo, 48kHz, Highest Performance, DVDD = 1.8V, AVDD = 1.8V AOSR = 128, Processing Block = PRB_R1 (Decimation Filter A) Device Common Mode Setting = 0.75V Device Common Mode Setting = 0.9V PTM_R1 PTM_R2 PTM_R3 PTM_R4 PTM_R1 PTM_R2 PTM_R3 PTM_R4 UNIT 0dB full scale X 375 375 375 X 500 500 500 mVRMS Max. allowed input level w.r.t. 0dB full scale X –12 0 0 X –12 0 0 dB full scale Effective SNR w.r.t. max. allowed input level X 78.5 90.7 90.2 X 80.4 92.9 92.7 dB Power consumption X 11.9 14.2 18.2 X 11.9 14.2 18.2 mW Alternative processing blocks: 2.5.2.2 Processing Block Filter Est. Power Change (mW) PRB_R2 A +1.4 PRB_R3 A +1.4 ADC, Stereo, 48kHz, DVDD = 1.8V, AVDD = 1.8V AOSR = 64, Processing Block = PRB_R7 (Decimation Filter B) Device Common Mode Setting = 0.75V Device Common Mode Setting = 0.9V PTM_R1 PTM_R2 PTM_R3 PTM_R4 PTM_R1 PTM_R2 PTM_R3 PTM_R4 UNIT 0dB full scale 375 X 375 X X X 500 X mVRMS Max. allowed input level w.r.t. 0dB full scale –2 X 0 X X X 0 X dB full scale Effective SNR w.r.t. max. allowed input level 86.0 X 88.1 X X X 90.4 X dB Power consumption 8.4 X 11.4 X X X 11.5 X mW Alternative processing blocks: Processing Block Filter Est. Power Change (mW) PRB_R8 B +0.7 PRB_R9 B +0.7 PRB_R1 A +2.0 PRB_R2 A +3.4 PRB_R3 A +3.4 SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated TLV320AIC3206 Application 55 PowerTune 2.5.2.3 www.ti.com ADC, Stereo, 48kHz, Lowest Power Consumption AOSR = 64, Processing Block = PRB_R7 (Decimation Filter B), DVDD = 1.26V PTM_R1 CM = 0.75V AVDD=1.5V PTM_R3 CM = 0.9V AVDD=1.8V UNIT 0dB full scale 375 500 mVRMS Max. allowed input level w.r.t. 0dB full scale –2 0 dB full scale Effective SNR w.r.t. max. allowed input level 88.0 92.2 dB Power consumption 6.0 11.4 mW Alternative processing blocks: 2.5.2.4 Processing Block Filter Est. Power Change (mW) PRB_R8 B + 0.3 PRB_R9 B + 0.3 PRB_R1 A + 1.0 PRB_R2 A + 1.6 PRB_R3 A + 1.6 ADC, Mono, 48kHz, Highest Performance, DVDD = 1.8V, AVDD = 1.8V AOSR = 128, Processing Block = PRB_R4 (Decimation Filter A) Device Common Mode Setting = 0.75V Device Common Mode Setting = 0.9V PTM_R1 PTM_R2 PTM_R3 PTM_R4 PTM_R1 PTM_R2 PTM_R3 PTM_R4 UNIT 0dB full scale X 375 375 375 X 500 500 500 mVRMS Max. allowed input level w.r.t. 0dB full scale X –12 0 0 X –12 0 0 dB full scale Effective SNR w.r.t. max. allowed input level X 78.3 90.8 90.6 X 80.3 92.8 92.7 dB Power consumption X 9.1 11.4 15.4 X 9.1 11.4 15.4 mW Alternative processing blocks: 56 Processing Block Filter Est. Power Change (mW) PRB_R5 A +0.7 PRB_R6 A +0.7 TLV320AIC3206 Application SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated PowerTune www.ti.com 2.5.2.5 ADC, Mono, 48kHz, DVDD = 1.8V, AVDD = 1.8V AOSR = 64, Processing Block = PRB_R11 (Decimation Filter B) Device Common Mode Setting = 0.75V Device Common Mode Setting = 0.9V PTM_R1 PTM_R2 PTM_R3 PTM_R4 PTM_R1 PTM_R2 PTM_R3 PTM_R4 UNIT 0dB full scale 375 X 375 X X X 500 X mVRMS Max. allowed input level w.r.t. 0dB full scale –2 X 0 X X X 0 X dB full scale Effective SNR w.r.t. max. allowed input level 86.0 X 88.1 X X X 90.3 X dB Power consumption 7.0 X 10.1 X X X 10.1 X mW Alternative processing blocks: 2.5.2.6 Processing Block Filter Est. Power Change (mW) PRB_R10 B 0 PRB_R12 B 0 PRB_R4 A +0.7 PRB_R5 A +1.4 PRB_R6 A +1.4 ADC, Mono, 48 kHz, Lowest Power Consumption, AOSR = 64, Processing Block = PRB_R11 (Decimation Filter B), DVDD = 1.26V PTM_R1 CM = 0.75V AVDD=1.5V PTM_R3 CM = 0.9V AVDD=1.8V UNIT 0dB full scale 375 500 mVRMS Max. allowed input level w.r.t. 0dB full scale –2 0 dB full scale Effective SNR w.r.t. max. allowed input level 86.0 90.5 dB Power consumption 5.1 9.2 mW Alternative processing blocks: Processing Block Filter Est. Power Change (mW) PRB_R10 B 0 PRB_R12 B 0 PRB_R4 A +0.3 PRB_R5 A +0.7 PRB_R6 A +0.7 SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated TLV320AIC3206 Application 57 PowerTune 2.5.2.7 www.ti.com ADC, Stereo, 8kHz, Highest Performance, DVDD = 1.8V, AVDD = 1.8V AOSR = 128, Processing Block = PRB_R1 (Decimation Filter A) Device Common Mode Setting = 0.75V Device Common Mode Setting = 0.9V PTM_R1 PTM_R2 PTM_R3 PTM_R4 PTM_R1 PTM_R2 PTM_R3 PTM_R4 0dB full scale UNIT 375 X X X 500 X X X mVRMS 0 X X X 0 X X X dB full scale Effective SNR w.r.t. max. allowed input level 91.1 X X X 93.2 X X X dB Power consumption 6.5 X X X 6.5 X X X mW Max. allowed input level w.r.t. 0dB full scale Alternative processing blocks: 2.5.2.8 Processing Block Filter Est. Power Change (mW) PRB_R2 A +0.2 PRB_R3 A +0.2 ADC, Stereo, 8kHz, DVDD = 1.8V, AVDD = 1.8V AOSR = 64, Processing Block = PRB_R7 (Decimation Filter B) Device Common Mode Setting = 0.75V Device Common Mode Setting = 0.9V PTM_R1 PTM_R2 PTM_R3 PTM_R4 PTM_R1 PTM_R2 PTM_R3 PTM_R4 0dB full scale UNIT 375 X X X 500 X X X mVRMS 0 X X X 0 X X X dB full scale Effective SNR w.r.t. max. allowed input level 88.2 X X X 90.6 X X X dB Power consumption 6.0 X X X 6.1 X X X mW Max. allowed input level w.r.t. 0dB full scale Alternative processing blocks: 58 Processing Block Filter Est. Power Change (mW) PRB_R8 B + 0.1 PRB_R9 B + 0.1 PRB_R1 A + 0.3 PRB_R2 A +0.6 PRB_R3 A + 0.6 TLV320AIC3206 Application SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated PowerTune www.ti.com 2.5.2.9 ADC, Stereo, 8kHz, Lowest Power Consumption, AOSR = 64, Processing Block = PRB_R7 (Decimation Filter B), PowerTune Mode = PTM_R1, DVDD = 1.26 CM = 0.75V AVDD=1.5V CM = 0.9V AVDD=1.8V 375 500 mVRMS 0 0 dB full scale Effective SNR w.r.t. max. allowed input level 88.3 92.4 dB Power consumption 4.7 5.8 mW 0dB full scale Max. allowed input level w.r.t. 0dB full scale UNIT Alternative processing blocks: Processing Block Filter Est. Power Change (mW) PRB_R8 B + 0.1 PRB_R9 B + 0.1 PRB_R1 A + 0.2 PRB_R2 A + 0.3 PRB_R3 A + 0.3 2.5.2.10 ADC, Mono, 8kHz, Highest Performance, DVDD = 1.8V, AVDD = 1.8V AOSR = 128, Processing Block = PRB_R4 (Decimation Filter A) Device Common Mode Setting = 0.75V Device Common Mode Setting = 0.9V PTM_R1 PTM_R2 PTM_R3 PTM_R4 PTM_R1 PTM_R2 PTM_R3 PTM_R4 0dB full scale UNIT 375 X X X 500 X X X mVRMS 0 X X X 0 X X X dB full scale Effective SNR w.r.t. max. allowed input level 88.5 X X X 93.3 X X X dB Power consumption 5.5 X X X 5.6 X X X mW Max. allowed input level w.r.t. 0dB full scale Alternative processing blocks: Processing Block Filter Est. Power Change (mW) PRB_R5 A +0.1 PRB_R6 A +0.1 SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated TLV320AIC3206 Application 59 PowerTune www.ti.com 2.5.2.11 ADC, Mono, 8kHz, DVDD = 1.8V, AVDD = 1.8V AOSR = 64, Processing Block = PRB_R11 (Decimation Filter B) Device Common Mode Setting = 0.75V Device Common Mode Setting = 0.9V PTM_R1 PTM_R2 PTM_R3 PTM_R4 PTM_R1 PTM_R2 PTM_R3 PTM_R4 0dB full scale UNIT 375 X X X 500 X X X mVRMS 0 X X X 0 X X X dB full scale Effective SNR w.r.t. max. allowed input level 88.1 X X X 93.0 X X X dB Power consumption 5.3 X X X 5.3 X X X mW Max. allowed input level w.r.t. 0dB full scale Alternative processing blocks: Processing Block Filter Est. Power Change (mW) PRB_R10 B 0 PRB_R12 B 0 PRB_R4 A +0.1 PRB_R5 A +0.2 PRB_R6 A +0.2 2.5.2.12 ADC, Mono, 8kHz, Lowest Power Consumption AOSR = 64, Processing Block = PRB_R11 (Decimation Filter B), PowerTune Mode = PTM_R1, DVDD = 1.26V CM = 0.75V AVDD=1.5V CM = 0.9V AVDD=1.8V 375 500 mVRMS 0 0 dB full scale Effective SNR w.r.t. max. allowed input level 88.2 89.9 dB Power consumption 4.2 5.0 mW 0dB full scale Max. allowed input level w.r.t. 0dB full scale UNIT Alternative processing blocks: 60 Processing Block Filter Est. Power Change (mW) PRB_R10 B 0 PRB_R12 B 0 PRB_R4 A +0.1 PRB_R5 A +0.1 PRB_R6 A +0.1 TLV320AIC3206 Application SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated PowerTune www.ti.com 2.5.2.13 ADC, Stereo, 192kHz, Highest Performance, DVDD = 1.8V, AVDD = 1.8V AOSR = 32, Processing Block = PRB_R14 (Decimation Filter C) Device Common Mode Setting = 0.75V Device Common Mode Setting = 0.9V PTM_R1 PTM_R2 PTM_R3 PTM_R4 PTM_R1 PTM_R2 PTM_R3 PTM_R4 UNIT 0dB full scale X X X 375 X X X 500 mVRMS Max. allowed input level w.r.t. 0dB full scale X X X 0 X X X 0 dB full scale Effective SNR w.r.t. max. allowed input level X X X 86.5 X X X 88.7 dB Power consumption X X X 21.9 X X X 21.9 mW Alternative processing blocks: Processing Block Filter Est. Power Change (mW) PRB_R13 C –2.7 PRB_R15 C 0 2.5.2.14 ADC, Stereo, 192kHz, Lowest Power Consumption AOSR = 32, Processing Block = PRB_R14 (Decimation Filter C), PowerTune Mode = PTM_R4, DVDD = 1.26V CM = 0.75V AVDD=1.5V CM = 0.9V AVDD=1.8V 375 500 mVRMS 0 0 dB full scale Effective SNR w.r.t. max. allowed input level 86.5 89.0 dB Power consumption 16.2 18.4 mW 0dB full scale Max. allowed input level w.r.t. 0dB full scale UNIT Alternative processing blocks: Processing Block Filter Est. Power Change (mW) PRB_R13 C – 1.3 PRB_R15 C 0 SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated TLV320AIC3206 Application 61 PowerTune www.ti.com 2.5.3 DAC Power Consumption The tables in this section give recommendations for various DAC PowerTune modes. Typical performance and power-consumption numbers are listed. PowerTune modes which are not supported are marked with an ‘X’. All measurements were taken with the PLL turned off, no signal is present, and the DAC modulator is fully running. The values given in the tables are intended as target-performance levels, not device specifications. For device specifications, see the TLV320AIC3206 data sheet, SLAS649. 2.5.3.1 DAC, Stereo, 48kHz, Highest Performance, DVDD = 1.8V, AVDD = 1.8V DOSR = 128, Processing Block = PRB_P8 (Interpolation Filter B) Device Common Mode Setting = 0.75V Device Common Mode Setting = 0.9V PTM_P1 PTM_P2 PTM_P3 PTM_P4 PTM_P1 PTM_P2 PTM_P3 PTM_P4 0dB full scale (1) UNIT 75 225 375 375 100 300 500 500 mVRMS 88.7 94.1 98.9 99.0 90.5 96.3 100.0 100.0 dB HP out (32Ω load) Effective SNR w.r.t. 0dB full scale Power consumption 9.4 10.1 10.9 10.9 9.5 10.1 10.9 10.9 mW Line out Effective SNR w.r.t. 0dB full scale 88.7 94.1 98.9 99.0 90.5 96.3 100.0 100.0 dB Power consumption 7.7 8.4 9.1 9.1 7.7 8.4 9.1 9.2 mW (1) Reduced 0dB full-scale swing can be compensated by applying appropriate gain in the output drivers see Section 2.4.4.1. Alternative processing blocks: 62 Processing Block Filter Est. Power Change (mW) PRB_P1 A 0 PRB_P2 A +3.1 PRB_P3 A +1.6 PRB_P7 B –1.6 PRB_P9 B 0 PRB_P10 B +1.6 PRB_P11 B –0.8 PRB_P23 A 0 PRB_P24 A +3.1 PRB_P25 A +3.1 TLV320AIC3206 Application SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated PowerTune www.ti.com 2.5.3.2 DAC, Stereo, 48kHz, Lowest Power Consumption DOSR = 64, Interpolation Filter B, DVDD = 1.26V CM = 0.75V AVDD=1.5V PRB_P8 PTM_P1 CM = 0.9V AVDD=1.8V PRB_P8 PTM_P1 CM = 0.75V AVDD=1.5V PRB_P7 PTM_P4 UNIT 75 100 375 mVRMS 0dB full scale (1) HP out (32Ω load) Effective SNR w.r.t. 0dB full scale 89.4 89.4 99.9 dB Power consumption 5.5 6.9 7.1 mW Line out Effective SNR w.r.t. 0dB full scale 89.5 91.2 100.1 dB Power consumption 4.2 4.1 5.1 mW (1) Reduced 0dB full-scale swing can be compensated by applying appropriate gain in the output drivers see Section 2.4.4.1. Alternative processing blocks: (1) 2.5.3.3 Processing Block Filter Est. Power Change (mW) PRB_P1 A 0 PRB_P2 A +1.5 PRB_P3 A +0.8 PRB_P7 B –0.8 PRB_P9 B 0 PRB_P10 B +0.8 PRB_P11 B 0 PRB_P23 A 0 PRB_P24 A +1.5 PRB_P25 A +1.5 (1) Estimated power change is w.r.t. PRB_P8. DAC, Mono, 48kHz, Highest Performance, DVDD = 1.8V, AVDD = 1.8V DOSR = 128, Processing Block = PRB_P13 (Interpolation Filter B) Device Common Mode Setting = 0.75V Device Common Mode Setting = 0.9V PTM_P1 PTM_P2 PTM_P3 PTM_P4 PTM_P1 PTM_P2 PTM_P3 PTM_P4 0dB full scale (1) 75 225 375 375 100 300 500 500 mVRMS 88.1 96.1 98.7 99.5 90.4 96.3 99.4 100 dB 6.5 6.5 mW 100 100 dB 5.7 mW HP out (32Ω load) Effective SNR w.r.t. 0dB full scale Power consumption 5.8 6.2 6.5 6.5 5.8 6.2 Line out Effective SNR w.r.t. 0dB full scale 89.6 97.1 100.3 100.3 90.5 96.3 Power consumption 5.0 5.4 5.7 5.7 5.0 5.4 5.7 (1) UNIT Reduced 0dB full-scale swing can be compensated by applying appropriate gain in the output drivers see Section 2.4.4.1. Alternative processing blocks: Processing Block Filter Est. Power Change(mW) PRB_P4 A 0 PRB_P5 A +1.6 PRB_P6 A +1.6 PRB_P12 B –0.8 PRB_P14 B 0 PRB_P15 B +1.6 SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated TLV320AIC3206 Application 63 PowerTune 2.5.3.4 www.ti.com Processing Block Filter Est. Power Change(mW) PRB_P16 B 0 DAC, Mono, 48kHz, Lowest Power Consumption DOSR = 64, Processing Block = PRB_P13 (Interpolation Filter B), PowerTune Mode = PTM_P1, DVDD = 1.26V CM = 0.75V AVDD=1.5V CM = 0.9V AVDD=1.8V UNIT 75 100 mVRMS 0dB full scale (1) HP out (32Ω load) Effective SNR w.r.t. 0dB full scale 88.9 90.8 dB Power consumption 3.4 3.8 mW Line out Effective SNR w.r.t. 0dB full scale 89.5 91.1 dB Power consumption 3.0 3.1 mW (1) Reduced 0dB full-scale swing can be compensated by applying appropriate gain in the output drivers see Section 2.4.4.1. Alternative processing blocks: 2.5.3.5 Processing Block Filter Est. Power Change (mW) PRB_P4 A 0 PRB_P5 A +0.8 PRB_P6 A +0.8 PRB_P12 B –0.4 PRB_P14 B 0 PRB_P15 B +0.8 PRB_P16 B 0 DAC, Stereo, 8kHz, Highest Performance, DVDD = 1.8V, AVDD = 1.8V DOSR = 768, Processing Block = PRB_P7 (Interpolation Filter B) Device Common Mode Setting = 0.75V Device Common Mode Setting = 0.9V PTM_P1 PTM_P2 PTM_P3 PTM_P4 PTM_P1 PTM_P2 PTM_P3 PTM_P4 0dB full scale UNIT 75 X X X 100 X X X mVRMS HP out (32Ω load) Effective SNR w.r.t. 0dB full scale (1) 88.7 X X X 90.5 X X X dB Power consumption 6.1 X X X 6.1 X X X mW Line out Effective SNR w.r.t. 0dB full scale 88.7 X X X 90.5 X X X dB Power consumption 3.6 X X X 4.3 X X X mW (1) Reduced 0dB full-scale swing can be compensated by applying appropriate gain in the output drivers see Section 2.4.4.1. Alternative processing blocks: 64 Processing Block Filter Est. Power Change (mW) PRB_P1 A +0.3 PRB_P2 A +0.8 PRB_P3 A +0.5 PRB_P8 B +0.3 PRB_P9 B +0.3 PRB_P10 B +0.5 PRB_P11 B +0.3 TLV320AIC3206 Application SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated PowerTune www.ti.com 2.5.3.6 Processing Block Filter Est. Power Change (mW) PRB_P23 A +0.3 PRB_P24 A +0.8 PRB_P25 A +0.8 DAC, Stereo, 8kHz, Lowest Power Consumption DOSR = 384, Processing Block = PRB_P7 (Interpolation Filter B), PowerTune Mode = PTM_P1, DVDD = 1.26V CM = 0.75V AVDD=1.5V 0dB full scale (1) CM = 0.9V AVDD=1.8V UNIT 75 100 mVRMS 88.4 90.2 dB mW HP out (32Ω load) Effective SNR w.r.t. 0dB full scale Power consumption 3.8 5.1 Line out Effective SNR w.r.t. 0dB full scale 89.6 91.1 dB Power consumption 2.4 2.9 mW (1) Reduced 0dB full-scale swing can be compensated by applying appropriate gain in the output drivers see Section 2.4.4.1. Alternative processing blocks: 2.5.3.7 Processing Block Filter Est. Power Change (mW) PRB_P1 A +0.1 PRB_P2 A +0.4 PRB_P3 A +0.3 PRB_P8 B +0.1 PRB_P9 B +0.1 PRB_P10 B +0.3 PRB_P11 B +0.1 PRB_P23 A +0.1 PRB_P24 A +0.4 PRB_P25 A +0.4 DAC, Mono, 8kHz, Highest Performance, DVDD = 1.8V, AVDD = 1.8V DOSR = 768, Processing Block = PRB_P4 (Interpolation Filter A) Device Common Mode Setting = 0.75V Device Common Mode Setting = 0.9V PTM_P1 PTM_P2 PTM_P3 PTM_P4 PTM_P1 PTM_P2 PTM_P3 PTM_P4 0dB full scale (1) UNIT 75 X X X 100 X X X mVRMS 89.4 X X X 89.8 X X X dB HP out (32Ω load) Effective SNR w.r.t. 0dB full scale Power consumption 4.4 X X X 4.4 X X X mW Line out Effective SNR w.r.t. 0dB full scale 89.6 X X X 91.2 X X X dB Power consumption 3.6 X X X 3.6 X X X mW (1) Reduced 0dB full-scale swing can be compensated by applying appropriate gain in the output drivers see Section 2.4.4.1. Alternative processing blocks: SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated TLV320AIC3206 Application 65 PowerTune 2.5.3.8 www.ti.com Processing Block Filter Est. Power Change (mW) PRB_P5 A +0.3 PRB_P6 A +0.3 PRB_P12 B –0.1 PRB_P13 B 0 PRB_P14 B 0 PRB_P15 B +0.3 PRB_P16 B 0 DAC, Mono, 8kHz, Lowest Power Consumption DOSR = 384, Processing Block = PRB_P4 (Interpolation Filter A), PowerTune Mode = PTM_P1, DVDD = 1.26V CM = 0.75V AVDD=1.5V 0dB full scale (1) HP out (32Ω load) Effective SNR w.r.t. 0dB full scale Line out (1) CM = 0.9V AVDD=1.8V UNIT 75 100 mVRMS 89.1 90.7 dB Power consumption 2.6 3.0 mW Effective SNR w.r.t. 0dB full scale 89.5 91.1 dB Power consumption 2.0 2.2 mW Reduced 0dB full-scale swing can be compensated by applying appropriate gain in the output drivers see Section 2.4.4.1. Alternative processing blocks: 2.5.3.9 Processing Block Filter Est. Power Change (mW) PRB_P5 A +0.1 PRB_P6 A +0.1 PRB_P12 B –0.1 PRB_P13 B 0 PRB_P14 B 0 PRB_P15 B +0.1 PRB_P16 B 0 DAC, Stereo, 192kHz, DVDD = 1.8V, AVDD = 1.8V DOSR = 32, Processing Block = PRB_P17 (Interpolation Filter C) Device Common Mode Setting = 0.75V Device Common Mode Setting = 0.9V PTM_P1 PTM_P2 PTM_P3 PTM_P4 PTM_P1 PTM_P2 PTM_P3 PTM_P4 0dB full scale UNIT X X X 375 X X X 500 mVRMS HP out (32Ω load) Effective SNR w.r.t. 0dB full scale X X X 99.1 X X X 99.9 dB Power consumption X X X 13.4 X X X 13.5 mW Line out Effective SNR w.r.t. 0dB full scale X X X 100.5 X X X 100.5 dB Power consumption X X X 11.3 X X X 11.3 mW (1) 66 (1) Reduced 0dB full-scale swing can be compensated by applying appropriate gain in the output drivers see Section 2.4.4.1. TLV320AIC3206 Application SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated PowerTune www.ti.com Alternative processing blocks: Processing Block Filter Est. Power Change (mW) PRB_P18 C +9.3 PRB_P19 C +3.1 SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated TLV320AIC3206 Application 67 Audio Digital I/O Interface www.ti.com 2.5.3.10 DAC, Stereo, 192kHz, Lowest Power Consumption DOSR = 16, Processing Block = PRB_R17 (Interpolation Filter C), PowerTune Mode = PTM_P4, DVDD = 1.26V CM = 0.75V AVDD=1.5V 0dB full scale (1) HP out (32Ω load) Line out (1) CM = 0.9V AVDD=1.8V UNIT 375 500 mVRMS Effective SNR w.r.t. 0dB full scale 99.4 100.3 dB Power consumption 7.7 8.9 mW Effective SNR w.r.t. 0dB full scale 100.4 100.4 dB Power consumption 6.1 6.7 mW Reduced 0dB full-scale swing can be compensated by applying appropriate gain in the output drivers see Section 2.4.4.1. Alternative processing blocks: 2.6 Processing Block Filter Est. Power Change (mW) PRB_P18 C +4.5 PRB_P19 C +1.5 Audio Digital I/O Interface Audio data flows between the host processor and the TLV320AIC3206 on the digital audio data serial interface, or audio bus. This very flexible bus includes left or right-justified data options, support for I2S or PCM protocols, programmable data length options, a TDM mode for multichannel operation, very flexible master-slave configurability for each bus clock line, and the ability to communicate with multiple devices within a system directly. The audio bus of the TLV320AIC3206 can be configured for left or right-justified, I2S, DSP, or TDM modes of operation, where communication with standard PCM interfaces is supported within the TDM mode. These modes are all MSB-first, with data width programmable as 16, 20, 24, or 32 bits by configuring Page 0, Register 27, D(5:4). In addition, the word clock and bit clock can be independently configured in either Master or Slave mode, for flexible connectivity to a wide variety of processors. The word clock is used to define the beginning of a frame, and may be programmed as either a pulse or a square-wave signal. The frequency of this clock corresponds to the maximum of the selected ADC and DAC sampling frequencies. The bit clock is used to clock in and clock out the digital audio data across the serial bus. When in Master mode, this signal can be programmed to generate variable clock pulses by controlling the bit-clock divider in Page 0, Register 30. The number of bit-clock pulses in a frame may need adjustment to accommodate various word lengths, and to support the case when multiple TLV320AIC3206s may share the same audio bus. The TLV320AIC3206 also includes a feature to offset the position of start of data transfer with respect to the word-clock. Control the offset in terms of number of bit-clocks by programming Page 0, Register 28. The TLV320AIC3206 also has the feature to invert the polarity of the bit-clock used to transfer the audio data as compared to the default clock polarity used. This feature can be used independently of the mode of audio interface chosen. Page 0, Register 29, D(3) configures bit clock polarity. The TLV320AIC3206 further includes programmability (Page 0, Register 27, D(0)) to place the DOUT line into a hi-Z (3-state) condition during all bit clocks when valid data is not being sent. By combining this capability with the ability to program at what bit clock in a frame the audio data begins, time-division multiplexing (TDM) can be accomplished, enabling the use of multiple codecs on a single audio serial data bus. When the audio serial data bus is powered down while configured in master mode, the pins associated with the interface are put into a hi-Z output condition. 68 TLV320AIC3206 Application SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated Audio Digital I/O Interface www.ti.com By default when the word-clocks and bit-clocks are generated by the TLV320AIC3206, these clocks are active only when the codec (ADC, DAC or both) are powered up within the device. This intermittent clock operation reduces power consumption. However, it also supports a feature when both the word clocks and bit-clocks can be active even when the codec in the device is powered down. This continuous clock feature is useful when using the TDM mode with multiple codecs on the same bus, or when word-clock or bit-clocks are used in the system as general-purpose clocks. 2.6.1 Right Justified Mode The Audio Interface of the TLV320AIC3206 can be put into Right Justified Mode by programming Page 0, Register 27, D(7:6) = 10b. In right-justified mode, the LSB of the left channel is valid on the rising edge of the bit clock preceding the falling edge of the word clock. Similarly, the LSB of the right channel is valid on the rising edge of the bit clock preceding the rising edge of the word clock. 1/fs WCLK BCLK Left Channel DIN/ DOUT 0 n-1 n-2 n-3 MSB Right Channel 2 1 0 LSB n-1 n-2 n-3 2 1 MSB 0 LSB Figure 2-38. Timing Diagram for Right-Justified Mode For Right-Justified mode, the number of bit-clocks per frame should be greater than twice the programmed word-length of the data. SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated TLV320AIC3206 Application 69 Audio Digital I/O Interface www.ti.com 2.6.2 Left Justified Mode The Audio Interface of the TLV320AIC3206 can be put into Left Justified Mode by programming Page 0, Register 27, D(7:6) = 11b. In left-justified mode, the MSB of the right channel is valid on the rising edge of the bit clock following the falling edge of the word clock. Similarly the MSB of the left channel is valid on the rising edge of the bit clock following the rising edge of the word clock. WORD CLOCK LEFT CHANNEL RIGHT CHANNEL BIT CLOCK DATA N N N - - 1 2 3 3 2 1 N N N - - 1 2 3 0 3 LD(n) 2 1 N N N - - 1 2 3 0 RD(n) LD(n) = n'th sample of left channel data LD(n+1) RD(n) = n'th sample of right channel data Figure 2-39. Timing Diagram for Left-Justified Mode WORD CLOCK LEFT CHANNEL RIGHT CHANNEL BIT CLOCK DATA N N N - - 1 2 3 3 2 1 0 N N N - - 1 2 3 LD(n) 3 2 1 0 RD(n) LD(n) = n'th sample of left channel data N N N - - 1 2 3 LD(n+1) RD(n) = n'th sample of right channel data Figure 2-40. Timing Diagram for Left-Justified Mode with Offset = 1 WORD CLOCK LEFT CHANNEL RIGHT CHANNEL BIT CLOCK DATA N N N - - 1 2 3 3 2 1 0 LD(n) N N N - - 1 2 3 3 2 1 0 RD(n) LD(n) = n'th sample of left channel data N N N - - 1 2 3 3 LD(n+1) RD(n) = n'th sample of right channel data Figure 2-41. Timing Diagram for Left-Justified Mode with Offset = 0 and inverted bit clock For Left-Justified mode, the number of bit-clocks per frame should be greater than twice the programmed word-length of the data. Also, the programmed offset value should be less than the number of bit-clocks per frame by at least the programmed word-length of the data. 70 TLV320AIC3206 Application SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated Audio Digital I/O Interface www.ti.com 2 2.6.3 I S Mode The Audio Interface of the TLV320AIC3206 can be put into I2S Mode by programming Page 0, Register 27, D(7:6) = to 00b. In I2S mode, the MSB of the left channel is valid on the second rising edge of the bit clock after the falling edge of the word clock. Similarly the MSB of the right channel is valid on the second rising edge of the bit clock after the rising edge of the word clock. WORD CLOCK LEFT CHANNEL RIGHT CHANNEL BIT CLOCK DATA N N N - - 1 2 3 3 2 1 N N N - - 1 2 3 0 LD(n) 3 2 1 N N N - - 1 2 3 0 RD(n) LD(n) = n'th sample of left channel data 3 LD(n+1) RD(n) = n'th sample of right channel data Figure 2-42. Timing Diagram for I2S Mode WORD CLOCK LEFT CHANNEL RIGHT CHANNEL BIT CLOCK DATA N 1 5 4 3 2 1 0 N 1 5 4 LD(n) 3 2 1 N 1 0 RD(n) LD(n) = n'th sample of left channel data 5 LD (n+1) RD(n) = n'th sample of right channel data Figure 2-43. Timing Diagram for I2S Mode with offset = 2 WORD CLOCK LEFT CHANNEL RIGHT CHANNEL BIT CLOCK DATA N N N - - 1 2 3 3 2 1 0 LD(n) N N N - - 1 2 3 3 2 1 N N N - - 1 2 3 0 RD(n) LD(n) = n'th sample of left channel data 3 LD(n+1) RD(n) = n'th sample of right channel data Figure 2-44. Timing Diagram for I2S Mode with offset = 0 and bit clock invert For I2S mode, the number of bit-clocks per channel should be greater than or equal to the programmed word-length of the data. Also the programmed offset value should be less than the number of bit-clocks per frame by at least the programmed word-length of the data. SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated TLV320AIC3206 Application 71 Audio Digital I/O Interface www.ti.com 2.6.4 DSP Mode The Audio Interface of the TLV320AIC3206 can be put into DSP Mode by programming Page 0, Register 27, D(7:6) = 01b. In DSP mode, the rising edge of the word clock starts the data transfer with the left channel data first and immediately followed by the right channel data. Each data bit is valid on the falling edge of the bit clock. WORD CLOCK LEFT CHANNEL RIGHT CHANNEL BIT CLOCK DATA N N N - - 1 2 3 3 2 1 0 N N N - - 1 2 3 LD(n) 3 2 1 N N N - - 1 2 3 0 RD(n) LD(n) = n'th sample of left channel data 3 LD (n+1) RD(n) = n'th sample of right channel data Figure 2-45. Timing Diagram for DSP Mode WORD CLOCK LEFT CHANNEL RIGHT CHANNEL BIT CLOCK DATA N N N - - 1 2 3 3 2 1 0 N N N - - 1 2 3 LD(n) 3 2 1 N N N - - 1 2 3 0 RD(n) LD(n) = n'th sample of left channel data LD(n+1) RD(n) = n'th sample of right channel data Figure 2-46. Timing Diagram for DSP Mode with offset = 1 WORD CLOCK LEFT CHANNEL RIGHT CHANNEL BIT CLOCK DATA N N N - - 1 2 3 3 LD(n) 2 1 0 N N N - - 1 2 3 3 2 1 N N N - - 1 2 3 0 RD(n) 3 LD(n+1) Figure 2-47. Timing Diagram for DSP Mode with offset = 0 and bit clock inverted For DSP mode, the number of bit-clocks per frame should be greater than twice the programmed wordlength of the data. Also the programmed offset value should be less than the number of bit-clocks per frame by at least the programmed word-length of the data. 72 TLV320AIC3206 Application SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated Audio Digital I/O Interface www.ti.com 2 2.6.5 Secondary I S The audio serial interface on the TLV320AIC3206 has an extensive IO control to allow communication with two independent processors for audio data. Each processor can communicate with the device one at a time. This feature is enabled by register programming of the various pin selections. BCLK BCLK BCLK BCLK_INT S_BCLK S_BCLK BCLK_OUT WCLK WCLK WCLK DAC_WCLK_INT S_WCLK DAC_FS S_WCLK ADC_FS DIN DOUT WCLK ADC_WCLK_INT DOUT_int DOUT DIN Audio Digital Serial Interface ADC_WCLK S_DIN Primary Audio Processor DIN DIN_INT GPIO SCLK S_DIN ADC_WCLK ADC_FS MISO GPIO SCLK BCLK BCLK2 S_BCLK BCLK_OUT DOUT Secondary Audio Processor BCLK_OUT GPIO DAC_FS SCLK WCLK BCLK MISO S_WCLK WCLK2 Clock Generation WCLK MISO DAC_FS DOUT ADC_FS ADC_FS GPIO S_DIN DOUT SCLK DOUT_int DIN MISO (S_DOUT) DIN Figure 2-48. Audio Serial Interface Multiplexing The secondary audio interface uses multifunction pins. For an overview on multifunction pins please see Section 2.1.1.1. Figure 2-48 illustrates possible audio interface routing. The multifunction pins SCLK and MISO are only available in I2C communication mode. This multiplexing capability allows the TLV320AIC3206 to communicate with two separate devices with independent I2S or PCM busses, one at a time. SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated TLV320AIC3206 Application 73 Clock Generation and PLL 2.7 www.ti.com Clock Generation and PLL The TLV320AIC3206 supports a wide range of options for generating clocks for the ADC and DAC sections as well as interface and other control blocks. The clocks for ADC and DAC require a source reference clock. This clock can be provided on variety of device pins such as MCLK, BCLK or GPI pins. The CODEC_CLKIN can then be routed through highly-flexible clock dividers to generate the various clocks required for the ADC and DAC sections. In the event that the desired audio clocks cannot be generated from the reference clocks on MCLK, BCLK or GPIO, the TLV320AIC3206 also provides the option of using the on-chip PLL which supports a wide range of fractional multiplication values to generate the required clocks. Starting from CODEC_CLKIN the TLV320AIC3206 provides several programmable clock dividers to help achieve a variety of sampling rates for ADC, DAC and clocks for the processing block. To minimize power consumption, the system ideally provides a master clock that is a suitable integer multiple of the desired sampling frequencies. In such cases, internal dividers can be programmed to set up the required internal clock signals at very low power consumption. For cases where such master clocks are not available, the built-in PLL can be used to generate a clock signal that serves as an internal master clock. In fact, this master clock can also be routed to an output pin and may be used elsewhere in the system. The clock system is flexible enough that it even allows the internal clocks to be derived directly from an external clock source, while the PLL is used to generate some other clock that is only used outside the TLV320AIC3206. Figure 2-49. Clock Distribution Tree CODEC _ CLKIN NADC ´ MADC ´ AOSR CODEC _ CLKIN ADC _ MOD _ CLK = NADC ´ MADC CODEC _ CLKIN DAC _ fS = NDAC ´ MDAC ´ DOSR CODEC _ CLKIN DAC _ MOD _ CLK = NDAC ´ MDAC ADC _ fS = (14) (15) (16) (17) Table 2-29. CODEC CLKIN Clock Dividers Divider Bits NDAC Page 0, Register 11, D(6:0) MDAC Page 0, Register 12, D(6:0) DOSR Page 0, Register 13, D(1:0) + Page 0, Register 14, D(7:0) NADC Page 0, Register 18, D(6:0) MADC Page 0, Register 19, D(6:0) AOSR Page 0, Register 20, D(7:0) The DAC Modulator is clocked by DAC_MOD_CLK. For proper power-up of the DAC Channel, these clocks must be enabled by configuring the NDAC and MDAC clock dividers ( Page 0,Register 11, D(7) = 1 and Page 0, Register 12, D(7) = 1). When the DAC channel is powered down, the device internally initiates a power-down sequence for proper shut-down. During this shut-down sequence, the NDAC and MDAC dividers must not be powered down, or else a proper low power shut-down may not take place. The user can read the power-status flag in Page 0, Register 37, D(7) and Page 0, Register 37, D(3). When both flags indicate power-down, the MDAC divider may be powered down, followed by the NDAC divider. 74 TLV320AIC3206 Application SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated Clock Generation and PLL www.ti.com The is clocked by ADC_MOD_CLK. For proper power-up of the ADC Channel, these clocks are enabled by the NADC and MADC clock dividers (Page 0,Register 18, D(7) = 1 and Page 0, Register 19, D(7) = 1). When the ADC channel is powered down, the device internally initiates a power-down sequence for proper shut-down. During this shut-down sequence, the NADC and MADC dividers must not be powered down, or else a proper low power shut-down may not take place. The user can read the power-status flag in Page 0, Register 36, D(6) and Page 0, Register 36, D(2). When both flags indicate power-down, the MADC divider may be powered down, followed by NADC divider. When ADC_CLK is derived from the NDAC divider output, the NDAC must be kept powered up till the power-down status flags for ADC do not indicate power-down. When the input to the AOSR clock divider is derived from DAC_MOD_CLK, then MDAC must be powered up when ADC_FS is needed ( such as when WCLK is generated by TLV320AIC3206 or AGC is enabled) and can be powered down only after the ADC power-down flags indicate power-down status. In general, all the root clock dividers should be powered down only after the child clock dividers have been powered down for proper operation. The TLV320AIC3206 also has options for routing some of the internal clocks to the output pins of the device to be used as general purpose clocks in the system. The feature is shown in Figure 2-50. DAC_MOD_CLK DAC_CLK ADC_MOD_CLK ADC_CLK BDIV_CLKIN ÷N N = 1,2,...,127,128 BCLK Figure 2-50. BCLK Output Options In the mode when TLV320AIC3206 is configured to drive the BCLK pin (Page 0, Register 27, D(3) = ’1’) it can be driven as divided value of BDIV_CLKIN. The division value can be programmed in Page 0, Register 30, D(6:0) from 1 to 128. The BDIV_CLKIN can itself be configured to be one of DAC_CLK, DAC_MOD_CLK, ADC_CLK or ADC_MOD_CLK by configuring the BDIV_CLKIN mux in Page 0, Register 29, D(1:0). Additionally a general purpose clock can be driven out on either GPIO, DOUT or MISO pin. This clock can be a divided-down version of CDIV_CLKIN. The value of this clock divider can be programmed from 1 to 128 by writing to Page 0, Register 26, D(6:0). The CDIV_CLKIN can itself be programmed as one of the clocks among the list shown in Figure 2-51. This configuration is available by programming the mux in Page 0, Register 25, D(2:0). SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated TLV320AIC3206 Application 75 Clock Generation and PLL www.ti.com DAC_MOD_CLK PLL_CLK MCLK BCLK DIN DAC_CLK ADC_MOD_CLK ADC_CLK CDIV_CLKIN ÷M M = 1,2,...,127,128 CLKOUT GPIO MISO DOUT Figure 2-51. General Purpose Clock Output Options Table 2-30. Maximum TLV320AIC3206 Clock Frequencies DVdd ≥ 1.26V DVdd ≥ 1.65V CODEC_CLKIN 50MHz 137MHz when NDAC is even, NADC is even 112MHz when NDAC is even, NADC is odd 110MHz when NDAC is odd, NADC is even 110MHz when NDAC is odd, NADC is odd ADC_CLK 25MHz 55.296MHz ADC_MOD_CLK 6.758MHz 6.758MHz ADC_FS 0.192MHz 0.192MHz DAC_CLK 25MHz 55.296MHz DAC_MOD_CLK 6.758MHz 4.2MHz when Class-D Mode Headphone is used 6.758MHz DAC_FS 0.192MHz 0.192MHz BDIV_CLKIN 25MHz 55.296MHz CDIV_CLKIN 50MHz 112MHz when M is odd 137MHz when M is even 2.7.1 PLL The TLV320AIC3206 has an on-chip PLL to generate the clock frequency for the audio ADC, DAC, and Digital Signal Processing blocks. The programmability of the PLL allows operation from a wide variety of clocks that may be available in the system. 76 TLV320AIC3206 Application SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated Clock Generation and PLL www.ti.com The PLL input supports clocks varying from 512kHz to 20MHz and is register programmable to enable generation of required sampling rates with fine resolution. The PLL can be turned on by writing to Page 0, Register 5, D(7). When the PLL is enabled, the PLL output clock PLL_CLK is given by the following equation: PLL _ CLKIN ´ R ´ J.D PLL _ CLK = P (18) R = 1, 2, 3, 4 J = 1, 2, 3, 4,… 63, and D = 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, … 9999 P = 1, 2, 3, 4, … 8 R, J, D, and P are register programmable. The PLL can be programmed via Page 0, Registers 5-8. The PLL can be turned on via Page 0, Register 5, D(7). The variable P can be programmed via Page 0, Register 5, D(6:4). The default register value for P is 1, and for J is 4. The variable R can be programmed via Page 0, Register 5, D(3:0). The default register value for R is 1. The variable J can be programmed via Page 0, Register 6, D(5:0). The variable D is 12bits, programmed into two registers. The MSB portion can be programmed via Page 0, Register 7, D(5:0), and the LSB portion is programmed via Page 0, Register 8, D(7:0). The default register value for D is 0. When the PLL is enabled the following conditions must be satisfied • When the PLL is enabled and D = 0, the following conditions must be satisfied for PLL_CLKIN: PLL _ CLKIN 512kHz £ £ 20MHz P (19) When the PLL is enabled and D ≠ 0, the following conditions must be satisfied for PLL_CLKIN: PLL _ CLKIN 10MHz £ £ 20MHz P (20) • In the TLV320AIC3206 the PLL_CLK supports a wide range of output clock, based on register settings and power-supply conditions. Table 2-31. PLL_CLK Frequency Range AVdd PLL Mode Page 0, Reg 4, D6 Min PLL_CLK frequency (MHz) Max PLL_CLK frequency (MHz) ≥1.5V 0 80 103 1 95 110 0 80 118 1 92 123 0 80 132 1 92 137 ≥1.65V ≥1.80V The PLL can be powered up independently from the ADC and DAC blocks, and can also be used as a general purpose PLL by routing its output to the GPIO output. After powering up the PLL, PLL_CLK is available typically after 10ms. The PLL output frequency is controlled by J.D and R dividers PLL Divider Bits J Page 0, Register 6, D(5:0) D Page 0, Register 7, D(5:0) and Page 0, Register 8, D(7:0) R Page 0, Register 5, D(3:0) The D-divider value is 14-bits wide and is controlled by 2 registers. For proper update of the D-divider value, Page 0, Register 7 must be programmed first followed immediately by Page 0, Register 8. Unless the write to Page 0, Register 8 is completed, the new value of D will not take effect. The clocks for codec and various signal processing blocks, CODEC_CLKIN can be generated from MCLK input, BCLK input, GPIO input or PLL_CLK (Page 0, Register 4, D(1:0)). SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated TLV320AIC3206 Application 77 Control Interfaces www.ti.com If the CODEC_CLKIN is derived from the PLL, then the PLL must be powered up first and powered down last. Table 2-32 lists several example cases of typical MCLK rates and how to program the PLL to achieve a sample rate fS of either 44.1kHz or 48kHz. Table 2-32. PLL Example Configurations fS = 44.1kHz MCLK (MHz) PLLP PLLR PLLJ PLLD MADC NADC AOSR MDAC NDAC DOSR 2.8224 1 3 10 0 3 5 128 3 5 128 5.6448 1 3 5 0 3 5 128 3 5 128 12 1 1 7 560 3 5 128 3 5 128 13 1 2 4 2336 13 3 64 4 6 104 16 1 1 5 2920 3 5 128 3 5 128 19.2 1 1 4 4100 3 5 128 3 5 128 48 4 1 7 560 3 5 128 3 5 128 2.048 1 3 14 0 2 7 128 7 2 128 3.072 1 4 7 0 2 7 128 7 2 128 4.096 1 3 7 0 2 7 128 7 2 128 6.144 1 2 7 0 2 7 128 7 2 128 8.192 1 4 3 0 2 8 128 4 4 128 12 1 1 7 1680 2 7 128 7 2 128 16 1 1 5 3760 2 7 128 7 2 128 19.2 1 1 4 4800 2 7 128 7 2 128 48 4 1 7 1680 2 7 128 7 2 128 fS = 48kHz 2.8 Control Interfaces The TLV320AIC3206 control interface supports SPI or I2C communication protocols, with the protocol selectable using the SPI_SELECT pin. For SPI, SPI_SELECT should be tied high; for I2C, SPI_SELECT should be tied low. Changing the state of SPI_SELECT during device operation is not recommended. 2.8.1 I2C Control Mode The TLV320AIC3206 supports the I2C control protocol, and will respond to the I2C address of 0011000. I2C is a two-wire, open-drain interface supporting multiple devices and masters on a single bus. Devices on the I2C bus only drive the bus lines LOW by connecting them to ground; they never drive the bus lines HIGH. Instead, the bus wires are pulled HIGH by pullup resistors, so the bus wires are HIGH when no device is driving them LOW. This circuit prevents two devices from conflicting; if two devices drive the bus simultaneously, there is no driver contention. Communication on the I2C bus always takes place between two devices, one acting as the master and the other acting as the slave. Both masters and slaves can read and write, but slaves can only do so under the direction of the master. Some I2C devices can act as masters or slaves, but the TLV320AIC3206 can only act as a slave device. An I2C bus consists of two lines, SDA and SCL. SDA carries data, and the SCL signal provides the clock. All data is transmitted across the I2C bus in groups of eight bits. To send a bit on the I2C bus, the SDA line is driven to the appropriate level while SCL is LOW (a LOW on SDA indicates the bit is zero, while a HIGH indicates the bit is one). Once the SDA line has settled, the SCL line is brought HIGH, then LOW. This pulse on the SCL line clocks the SDA bit into the receiver’s shift register. The I2C bus is bidirectional: the SDA line is used both for transmitting and receiving data. When a master reads from a slave, the slave drives the data line; when a master sends to a slave, the master drives the data line. 78 TLV320AIC3206 Application SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated Control Interfaces www.ti.com Most of the time the bus is idle, no communication is taking place, and both lines are HIGH. When communication is taking place, the bus is active. Only master devices can start communication on the bus. Normally, the data line is only allowed to change state while the clock line is LOW. If the data line changes state while the clock line is HIGH, it is either a START condition or its counterpart, a STOP condition. A START condition is when the clock line is HIGH and the data line goes from HIGH to LOW. A STOP condition is when the clock line is HIGH and the data line goes from LOW to HIGH. After the master issues a START condition, it sends a byte that selects the slave device for communication. This byte is called the address byte. Each device on an I2C bus has a unique 7-bit address to which it responds. (Slaves can also have 10-bit addresses; see the I2C specification for details.) The master sends an address in the address byte, together with a bit that indicates whether it wishes to read from or write to the slave device. Every byte transmitted on the I2C bus, whether it is address or data, is acknowledged with an acknowledge bit. When a master has finished sending a byte (eight data bits) to a slave, it stops driving SDA and waits for the slave to acknowledge the byte. The slave acknowledges the byte by pulling SDA LOW. The master then sends a clock pulse to clock the acknowledge bit. Similarly, when a master has finished reading a byte, it pulls SDA LOW to acknowledge this to the slave. The master then sends a clock pulse to clock the bit. (Remember that the master always drives the clock line.) A not-acknowledge is performed by simply leaving SDA HIGH during an acknowledge cycle. If a device is not present on the bus, and the master attempts to address it, it will receive a not−acknowledge because no device is present at that address to pull the line LOW. When a master has finished communicating with a slave, it may issue a STOP condition. When a STOP condition is issued, the bus becomes idle again. A master may also issue another START condition. When a START condition is issued while the bus is active, it is called a repeated START condition. The TLV320AIC3206 can also respond to and acknowledge a General Call, which consists of the master issuing a command with a slave address byte of 00H. This feature is disabled by default, but can be enabled via Page 0, Register 34, Bit D(5). SCL DA(6) SDA Start (M) DA(0) 7-bit Device Address (M) RA(7) Write (M) Slave Ack (S) RA(0) 8-bit Register Address (M) D(7) Slave Ack (S) D(0) 8-bit Register Data (M) Slave Ack (S) Stop (M) (M) => SDA Controlled by Master (S) => SDA Controlled by Slave Figure 2-52. I2C Write SCL DA(6) SDA Start (M) DA(0) 7-bit Device Address (M) RA(7) Write (M) Slave Ack (S) DA(6) RA(0) 8-bit Register Address (M) Slave Ack (S) Repeat Start (M) DA(0) 7-bit Device Address (M) D(7) Read (M) Slave Ack (S) 8-bit Register Data (S) D(0) Master No Ack (M) Stop (M) (M) => SDA Controlled by Master (S) => SDA Controlled by Slave Figure 2-53. I2C Read In the case of an I2C register write, if the master does not issue a STOP condition, then the device enters auto-increment mode. So in the next eight clocks, the data on SDA is treated as data for the next incremental register. Similarly, in the case of an I2C register read, after the device has sent out the 8-bit data from the addressed register, if the master issues a ACKNOWLEDGE, the slave takes over control of SDA bus and transmit for the next 8 clocks the data of the next incremental register. SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated TLV320AIC3206 Application 79 Control Interfaces www.ti.com 2.8.2 SPI Digital Interface In the SPI control mode, the TLV320AIC3206 uses the pins SCL/SS as SS, SCLK as SCLK, MISO as MISO, SDA/MOSI as MOSI; a standard SPI port with clock polarity setting of 0 (typical microprocessor SPI control bit CPOL = 0). The SPI port allows full-duplex, synchronous, serial communication between a host processor (the master) and peripheral devices (slaves). The SPI master (in this case, the host processor) generates the synchronizing clock (driven onto SCLK) and initiates transmissions. The SPI slave devices (such as the TLV320AIC3206) depend on a master to start and synchronize transmissions. A transmission begins when initiated by an SPI master. The byte from the SPI master begins shifting in on the slave MOSI pin under the control of the master serial clock (driven onto SCLK). As the byte shifts in on the MOSI pin, a byte shifts out on the MISO pin to the master shift register. The TLV320AIC3206 interface is designed so that with a clock-phase bit setting of 1 (typical microprocessor SPI control bit CPHA = 1), the master begins driving its MOSI pin and the slave begins driving its MISO pin on the first serial clock edge. The SSZ pin can remain low between transmissions; however, the TLV320AIC3206 only interprets the first 8 bits transmitted after the falling edge of SSZ as a command byte, and the next 8 bits as a data byte only if writing to a register. Reserved register bits should be written to their default values. The TLV320AIC3206 is entirely controlled by registers. Reading and writing these registers is accomplished by an 8-bit command sent to the MOSI pin of the part prior to the data for that register. The command is structured as shown in Table 2-33. The first 7 bits specify the register address which is being written or read, from 0 to 127 (decimal). The command word ends with an R/W bit, which specifies the direction of data flow on the serial bus. In the case of a register write, the R/W bit should be set to 0. A second byte of data is sent to the MOSI pin and contains the data to be written to the register. Reading of registers is accomplished in similar fashion. The 8-bit command word sends the 7bit register address, followed by R/W bit = 1 to signify a register read is occurring. The 8-bit register data is then clocked out of the part on the MISO pin during the second 8 SCLK clocks in the frame. Table 2-33. SPI Command Word Bit 7 ADDR(6) Bit 6 ADDR(5) Bit 5 ADDR(4) Bit 4 ADDR(3) Bit 3 ADDR(2) Bit 2 ADDR(1) Bit 1 ADDR(0) Bit 0 R/WZ SS SCLK MOSI Hi-Z RA(6) RA(5) 7-bit Register Address MISO RA(0) D(7) Write D(6) D(0) Hi-Z 8-bit Register Data Hi-Z Hi-Z Figure 2-54. SPI Timing Diagram for Register Write 80 TLV320AIC3206 Application SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated Power Supply www.ti.com SS SCLK MOSI Hi-Z RA(6) RA(5) 7-bit Register Address MISO Hi-Z RA(0) Hi-Z Don’t Care Read 8-bit Register Data D(7) D(6) D(0) Hi-Z Figure 2-55. SPI Timing Diagram for Register Read 2.9 Power Supply The device has an integrated charge pump. In ground-centered headphone configuration, all supplies can be conveniently supplied from a single 1.5V to 1.95V rail. The device has separate power domains for digital IO, digital core, analog core, charge-pump input and headphone drive, all of which can be connected together and be supplied from one source. For improved power efficiency, the digital core voltage can range from 1.26V to 1.95V. The IO voltage can be supplied in the range of 1.1V to 3.6V. The device power supply Vsys can be supplied in the range of 1.5V to 5.5V. Vsys must always be greater than or equal to AVdd and DVdd voltages. The TLV320AIC3206 has a total of six power-supply connections. • Vsys - The Vsys supply biases the device. The voltage on Vsys can range from 1.5V to 5.5V, but must always be greater than the voltage on AVdd and DVdd pins. • IOVdd - The IOVdd pin supplies the digital IO cells of the device. The voltage of IOVdd can range from 1.1 to 3.6V and is determined by the digital IO voltage of the rest of the system. • DVdd - This pin supplies the digital core of the device. Lower DVdd voltages cause lower power dissipation. If efficient switched-mode power supplies are used in the system, system power can be optimized using low DVdd voltages. the full clock range is supported with DVdd in the range of 1.65 to 1.95V. Also, operation with DVdd down to 1.26V is possible. (See Table 2-30) • DVdd_CP - The internal charge pump is supplied through this pin. • AVdd - This pin supplies the analog core of the device. The analog core voltage (AVdd) should be in the range of 1.5 to 1.95V for specified performance. For AVdd voltages above 1.8V, the internal common mode voltage can be set to 0.9V (Page 1 / Register 10, D(6)=0, default) resulting in 500mVrms full-scale voltage internally. For AVdd voltages below 1.8V, the internal common mode voltage should be set to 0.75V (Page 1 / Register 10, D(6)=1), resulting in 375mVrms internal full scale voltage. • DRVdd_HP - This pin supplies the headphone amplifier stage. In ground centered configuration theDRVdd_HP voltage should be in the range of 1.5 to 1.95V. In unipolar configuration the voltage should be in the range of 1.5 to 3.6V. NOTE: At powerup, AVdd is weakly connected to DVdd. This coarse AVdd generation must be turned off by writing Page 1 / Register 1, D(3) = 1 at the time AVdd is applied. 2.9.0.1 Single Supply Operation When all the power supplies to the TLV320AIC3206 are not at steady state, the hardware reset pin, RESET, must be kept pulled low. The RESET pin must only be pulled high after all the power supplies to the device stabilize at steady state. SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated TLV320AIC3206 Application 81 Reference Voltage www.ti.com Using the TLV320AIC3206 in its primary headphone configuration, the ground centered configuration, all supply pins can be connected together and supplied from a single 1.5V to 1.95V supply. For highest analog performance this voltage rail must be free from excessive voltage ripple. 2.9.0.2 Other Supply Options - Power Up Sequence The digital supply operates as low as 1.26V for lowest power consumption. In this case, the DVdd voltage must be supplied separately from the remaining supplies, and must be powered up and stable before powering up the remaining power rail of 1.5 to 1.95V. To supply the power pins from independent supplies, the powerup sequence is: Vsys, IOVdd, DVdd, DVdd_CP, AVdd and then DRVdd_HP. Multiple domains may be powered up at the same time. 2.10 Reference Voltage All data converters require a DC reference voltage. The TLV320AIC3206 achieves its low-noise performance by internally generating a low-noise reference voltage. This reference voltage is generated using a band-gap circuit with a good PSRR performance. This reference voltage must be filtered externally using a minimum 1μF capacitor connected from the REF pin to analog ground (AVSS). To achieve low power consumption, this reference block is powered down when all analog blocks inside the device are powered down. In this condition, the REF pin is 3-stated. On powerup of any analog block, the reference block also powers up and the REF pin settles to its steady-state voltage after the settling time (a function of the decoupling capacitor on the REF pin). This time is approximately 1 second when using a 1μF decoupling capacitor. In the event that a faster power-up is required, the reference block can be kept powered up (even when no other analog block is powered up) by programming Page 1, Register 123, D(2) = 1. However, in this case, an additional 125μA of current from AVDD is consumed. Additionally, to achieve a faster powerup, a fast-charge option is also provided where the charging time can be controlled between 40ms and 120ms by programming Page 1, Register 123, D(1:0). By default, the fast charge option is disabled. 2.11 Device Special Functions 2.11.1 Headset Detection The TLV320AIC3206 includes extensive capability to monitor a headphone, microphone, or headset jack, to determine if a plug has been inserted into the jack, and then determine what type of headset is wired to the plug. The device also includes the capability to detect a button press, even, for example, when starting calls on mobile phones with headsets. This feature is available while using I2C protocol for control interface. The figure shows the circuit configuration to enable this feature. 1 s g s 3 s HPR g HPL s Micpga m m MICDET MICBIAS Micbias Figure 2-56. Jack Connections for Headset Detection 82 TLV320AIC3206 Application SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated Device Special Functions www.ti.com This feature is enabled by programming Page 0, Register 67, D(1). In order to avoid false detections due to mechanical vibrations in headset jacks or microphone buttons, a debounce function is provided for glitch rejection. For the case of headset insertion, a debounce function with a range of 32ms - 512ms is provided. This function can be programmed via Page 0, Register 67, D(4:2). For improved button-press detection, the debounce function has a range of 8ms to 32ms by programming Page 0, Register 67, D(1:0). The TLV320AIC3206 also provides feedback to user when a button press, or a headset insertion or removal event is detected through register readable flags as well as an interrupt on the IO pins. The value in Page 0, Register 46, D(5:4) provides the instantaneous state of button press and headset insertion. Page 0, Register 44, D(5) is a sticky (latched) flag that is set when the button-press event is detected. Page 0, Register 44, D(4) is a sticky flag which is set when the headset insertion or removal event is detected. These sticky flags are set by the event occurrence, and are reset only when read, requiring the software to poll Page 0, Register 44. To avoid polling and the associated overhead, the TLV320AIC3206 also provides an interrupt feature where the events can trigger the INT1 and-or INT2 interrupts. These interrupt events can be routed to one of the digital output pins. Please see Section 2.11.2 for details. The TLV320AIC3206 not only detects a headset insertion event, but also is able to distinguish between the different headsets inserted such as stereo headphones or cellular headphones. After the headsetdetection event, the user can read Page 0, Register 67, D(6:5) to determine the type of headset inserted. Table 2-34. Headset Detection Block Registers Register Description Page 0, Register 67, D(1) Headset Detection Enable or Disable Page 0, Register 67, D(4:2) Debounce Programmability for Headset Detection Page 0, Register 67, D(1:0) Debounce Programmability for Button Press Page 0, Register 44, D(5) Sticky Flag for Button Press Event Page 0, Register 44, D(4) Sticky Flag for Headset Insertion or Removal Event Page 0, Register 46, D(5) Status Flag for Button Press Event Page 0, Register 46, D(4) Status Flag for Headset Insertion and Removal Page 0, Register 67, D(6:5) Flags for type of Headset Detected The headset detection block requires AVdd to be powered and Master Analog Power control in Page 1, Register 2, D(3) to be enabled. The headset detection feature in the TLV320AIC3206 is achieved with a very low power overhead, requiring less than 20μA of additional current from the AVdd supply. 2.11.2 Interrupts Some specific events in the TLV320AIC3206 which may require host processor intervention, can be used to trigger interrupts to the host processor. INterrupt use avoids polling the status-flag registers continuously. The TLV320AIC3206 has two defined interrupts; INT1 and INT2 that can be configured by programming Page 0, Register 48 and 49. A user can configure the interrupts INT1 and INT2 to be triggered by one or many events such as • Headset Detection • Button Press • DAC DRC Signal exceeding Threshold • Over-current condition in headphones • Data Overflow in ADC and DAC Processing Blocks and Filters Each of these INT1 and INT2 interrupts can be routed to output pins like GPIO, DOUT and MISO by configuring the respective output control registers in Page 0, Register 52, 53 and 55. These interrupt signals can either be configured as a single pulse or a series of pulses by programming Page 0, Register 48, D(0) and Page 0, Register 49, D(0). If the user configures the interrupts as a series of pulses, the events will trigger the start of pulses that will stop when the flag registers in Page 0, Register 42, 44 and 45 are read by the user to determine the cause of the interrupt. SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated TLV320AIC3206 Application 83 Chapter 3 SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Device Initialization The requirements of the application circuit determine device setup details such as clock generation, power sources, references voltage,and special functions that may add value to the end application. Example device setups are described in the final section. Topic 3.1 3.2 3.3 3.4 3.5 84 ........................................................................................................................... Reset ............................................................................................................... Device Startup Lockout Times ............................................................................ Analog and Reference Startup ............................................................................ PLL Startup ...................................................................................................... Setting Device Common Mode Voltage ................................................................ Device Initialization Page 85 85 85 85 85 SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated Reset www.ti.com 3.1 Reset The TLV320AIC3206 internal logic must be initialized to a known condition for proper device function. To initialize the device to the default operation condition, the hardware reset pin (RESET) must be pulled low for at least 10ns. For this initialization to work, both the IOVDD and DVDD supplies must be powered up. While the TLV320AIC3206 supplies are powering up, pull the RESET pin low. To allow hardware reset control independent of system power supply, drive the RESET pin through a GPIO terminal from the host processor. While the device requires a hardware reset after the power supplies are powered up, subsequently the device can be reset via software reset. Writing ‘1’ into Page 0, Register 1, D(0) resets the device. After a device reset, all registers are initialized with default values as listed in the Register Map section. 3.2 Device Startup Lockout Times After the TLV320AIC3206 initializes through hardware reset at power-up or software reset, the internal registers initialize to default values. This initialization takes place within 1ms after pulling the RESET signal high. During this initialization phase, no register-read or register-write operation should be performed on ADC or DAC coefficient buffers. Also, no block within the codec should be powered up during the initialization phase. 3.3 Analog and Reference Startup The TLV320AIC3206 uses an external REF pin for decoupling the reference voltage used for the data converters and other analog blocks. The REF pin requires a minimum 1µF decoupling capacitor from REF to AVSS. In order for any analog block to be powered up, the Analog Reference block must be powered up. By default, the Analog Reference block is implicitly powered up when any analog block is powered up, or it can be powered up independently. Detailed descriptions of Analog Reference including fast power-up options are provided in Section 2.10. During the time that the reference block is not completely powered up, subsequent requests for powering up analog blocks (such as the PLL) are queued, and executed after the reference power up is complete. 3.4 PLL Startup When the PLL is powered up, a startup delay of approximately 10ms is involved after the power up command of the PLL and before the clocks are available to the codec. This delay provides stable operation of PLL and clock-divider logic. 3.5 Setting Device Common Mode Voltage The TLV320AIC3206 allows the user to set the common mode voltage for analog inputs to 0.75V or 0.9V by programming Page 1, Register 10, D(6). The input common-mode voltage of 0.9V works best when the analog supply voltage is centered around 1.8V or above, and offers the highest possible performance. For analog supply voltages below 1.8V, a common mode voltage of 0.75V must be used. Table 3-1. Input Common Mode voltage and Input Signal Swing Input Common Mode Voltage (V) AVdd (V) Channel Gain (dB) Single-Ended Input Swing for 0dBFS output signal (VRMS) Differential Input Swing for 0dBFS output signal (VRMS) 0.75 >1.5 –2 0.375 0.75 0.90 1.8 … 1.95 0 0.5 1.0 The choice of input common mode of 0.75V allows the use of PowerTune mode PTM_R1 which results in significantly lower power dissipation. (see Section 2.5.1) An input common-mode voltage of 0.9V allows the user to maximize the signal swings and SNR. NOTE: The input common mode setting is common for ADC record, DAC playback and Analog Bypass path SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated Device Initialization 85 Chapter 4 SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Example Setups The following example setups can be taken directly for the TLV320AIC3206 EVM setup. The # marks a comment line, w marks an I2C write command followed by the device address, the I2C register address and the value. 4.1 Stereo DAC Playback with 48ksps Sample Rate, GCHP 4.1.1 Setup A - High Audio Output Power, High Performance ##### Setup A - High Audio Output Power, High Performance ####### ################# Software Reset ############################### w 30 00 00 # Select Page 0 w 30 01 01 # Software Reset d 1 # Delay 1 millisecond ##### Power and Analog Configuration ########################### w 30 00 01 # Select Page 1 w 30 01 08 # Disable weak AVDD to DVDD connection w 30 02 00 # Enable Master Analog Power Control w 30 7b 01 # REF charging time = 40ms w 30 7c 06 # 8/8 CP Sizing (Setup A), Div = 6, 333kHz w 30 01 0a # CP powered, source = int 8MHz OSC w 30 0a 00 # Full chip CM = 0.9V (Setup A) w 30 03 00 # PTM_P3, High Performance (Setup A) w 30 04 00 # PTM_P3, High Performance (Setup A) ####### Clock and Interface Configuration ###################### # -------------------------------------------------------------# MCLK = 11.2896 MHz, BLCK = 2.8224 MHz, WCLK = 44.1 kHz (slave) # -------------------------------------------------------------w 30 00 00 # Select Page 0 w 30 0b 81 # NDAC = 1 w 30 0c 82 # MDAC = 2 (Setup A) w 30 0D 00 80 # DOSR = 128 (Setup A) ####### Signal Processing Settings############################## w 30 00 00 # Select Page 0 w 30 3c 01 # Set the DAC Mode to PRB_P1 (Setup A) ######## Output Channel Configuration########################### w 30 00 01 # Select Page 1 w 30 0c 08 # Route LDAC to HPL w 30 0d 08 # Route RDAC to HPR w 30 00 00 # Select Page 0 w 30 3f d6 # Power up LDAC/RDAC w 30 00 01 # Select Page 1 w 30 7d 13 # GCHP Mode, OC for all, HP Sizing (Setup A) w 30 10 00 # Unmute HPL driver, 0dB Gain (Setup A) w 30 11 00 # Unmute HPR driver, 0dB Gain (Setup A) w 30 09 30 # Power up HPL/HPR drivers f 30 02 xxxxx1xx # Wait for offset correction to finish w 30 00 00 # Select Page 0 w 30 40 00 # Unmute LDAC/RDAC 86 Example Setups SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated Stereo DAC Playback with 48ksps Sample Rate, GCHP www.ti.com 4.1.2 Setup B - Medium Audio Output Power, High Performance #### Setup B - Medium Audio Output Power, High Performance###### ########## Software Reset #################################### w 30 00 00 # Select Page 0 w 30 01 01 # Software Reset d 1 # Delay 1 millisecond ########### Power and Analog Configuration ##################### w 30 00 01 # Select Page 1 w 30 01 08 # Disable weak AVDD to DVDD connection w 30 02 00 # Enable Master Analog Power Control w 30 7b 01 # REF charging time = 40ms w 30 7c 06 # 8/8 CP Sizing (Setup B), Div = 6, 333kHz w 30 01 0a # CP powered, source = int 8MHz OSC w 30 0a 40 # Full chip CM = 0.75V (Setup B) w 30 03 24 # PTM_P2, Low Power (Setup B) w 30 04 24 # PTM_P2, Low Power (Setup B) ############ Clock and Interface Configuration ################# # -------------------------------------------------------------# MCLK = 11.2896 MHz, BLCK = 2.8224 MHz, WCLK = 44.1 kHz (slave) ################################################################ w 30 00 00 # Select Page 0 w 30 0b 81 # NDAC = 1 w 30 0c 84 # MDAC = 4 (Setup B) w 30 0D 00 40 # DOSR = 64 (Setup B) ############ Signal Processing Settings ####################### w 30 00 00 # Select Page 0 w 30 3c 08 # Set the DAC Mode to PRB_P8 (Setup B) ##################### Output Channel Configuration ############# w 30 00 01 # Select Page 1 w 30 0c 08 # Route LDAC to HPL w 30 0d 08 # Route RDAC to HPR w 30 00 00 # Select Page 0 w 30 3f d6 # Power up LDAC/RDAC w 30 00 01 # Select Page 1 w 30 7d 13 # GCHP Mode, OC for all, HP Sizing (Setup B) w 30 10 05 # Unmute HPL driver, 5dB Gain (Setup B) w 30 11 05 # Unmute HPR driver, 5dB Gain (Setup B) w 30 09 30 # Power up HPL/HPR drivers f 30 02 xxxxx1xx # Wait for offset correction to finish w 30 00 00 # Select Page 0 w 30 40 00 # Unmute LDAC/RDAC SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated Example Setups 87 Stereo DAC Playback with 48ksps Sample Rate, GCHP www.ti.com 4.1.3 Setup C - High Audio Output Power, Low Power Consumption ##### Setup C - High Audio Output Power, Low Power Consumption ####### ############### Software Reset ##################### w 30 00 00 # Select Page 0 w 30 01 01 # Software Reset d 1 # Delay 1 millisecond ############ Power and Analog Configuration #################### w 30 00 01 # Select Page 1 w 30 01 08 # Disable weak AVDD to DVDD connection w 30 02 00 # Enable Master Analog Power Control w 30 7b 01 # REF charging time = 40ms w 30 7c 06 # 8/8 CP Sizing (Setup C), Div = 6, 333kHz w 30 01 0a # CP powered, source = int 8MHz OSC w 30 0a 40 # Full chip CM = 0.75V (Setup C) w 30 03 04 # PTM_P2, High Performance (Setup C) w 30 04 04 # PTM_P2, High Performance (Setup C) ######## Clock and Interface Configuration ##################### # -------------------------------------------------------------# MCLK = 11.2896 MHz, BLCK = 2.8224 MHz, WCLK = 44.1 kHz (slave) ################################################################ w 30 00 00 # Select Page 0 w 30 0b 81 # NDAC = 1 w 30 0c 84 # MDAC = 4 (Setup C) w 30 0D 00 40 # DOSR = 64 (Setup C) ############ Signal Processing Settings ######################## w 30 00 00 # Select Page 0 w 30 3c 08 # Set the DAC Mode to PRB_P8 (Setup C) ############ Output Channel Configuration ###################### w 30 00 01 # Select Page 1 w 30 0c 08 # Route LDAC to HPL w 30 0d 08 # Route RDAC to HPR w 30 00 00 # Select Page 0 w 30 3f d6 # Power up LDAC/RDAC w 30 00 01 # Select Page 1 w 30 7d 13 # GCHP Mode, OC for all, HP Sizing (Setup C) w 30 10 05 # Unmute HPL driver, 5dB Gain (Setup C) w 30 11 05 # Unmute HPR driver, 5dB Gain (Setup C) w 30 09 30 # Power up HPL/HPR drivers f 30 02 xxxxx1xx # Wait for offset correction to finish w 30 00 00 # Select Page 0 w 30 40 00 # Unmute LDAC/RDAC 88 Example Setups SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated Stereo DAC Playback with 48ksps Sample Rate, GCHP www.ti.com 4.1.4 Setup D - Medium Audio Output Power, Lowest Power Consumption ##### Setup D - Medium Audio Output Power, Lowest Power Consumption #### ######## Software Reset ############################ w 30 00 00 # Select Page 0 w 30 01 01 # Software Reset d 1 # Delay 1 millisecond ##### Power and Analog Configuration ################## w 30 00 01 # Select Page 1 w 30 01 08 # Disable weak AVDD to DVDD connection w 30 02 00 # Enable Master Analog Power Control w 30 7b 01 # REF charging time = 40ms w 30 7c 16 # 1/8 CP Sizing (Setup D), Div = 6, 333kHz w 30 01 0a # CP powered, source = int 8MHz OSC w 30 0a 40 # Full chip CM = 0.75V (Setup D) w 30 03 28 # PTM_P1, Low Power (Setup D) w 30 04 28 # PTM_P1, Low Power (Setup D) ######## Clock and Interface Configuration ################### # -------------------------------------------------------------# MCLK = 11.2896 MHz, BLCK = 2.8224 MHz, WCLK = 44.1 kHz (slave) ################################################################ w 30 00 00 # Select Page 0 w 30 0b 81 # NDAC = 1 (Setup D) w 30 0c 84 # MDAC = 4 (Setup D) w 30 0D 00 40 # DOSR = 64 (Setup D) ###### Signal Processing Settings #################### w 30 00 00 # Select Page 0 w 30 3c 08 # Set the DAC Mode to PRB_P8 (Setup D) ####### w 30 00 w 30 0c w 30 0d w 30 00 w 30 41 w 30 3f w 30 00 w 30 7d w 30 10 w 30 11 w 30 09 f 30 02 w 30 00 w 30 40 Output Channel Configuration ################### 01 # Select Page 1 08 # Route LDAC to HPL 08 # Route RDAC to HPR 00 # Select Page 0 F8 F8 # LDAC/RDAC Gain = -4dB d6 # Power up LDAC/RDAC 01 # Select Page 1 1F # GCHP Mode, OC for all, HP Sizing (Setup D) 0E # Unmute HPL driver, 14dB Gain (Setup D) 0E # Unmute HPR driver, 14dB Gain (Setup D) 30 # Power up HPL/HPR drivers xxxxx1xx # Wait for offset correction to finish 00 # Select Page 0 00 # Unmute LDAC/RDAC SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated Example Setups 89 Stereo ADC with 48ksps Sample Rate and High Performance 4.2 www.ti.com Stereo ADC with 48ksps Sample Rate and High Performance Assumption AVdd = 1.8V, DVdd = 1.8V MCLK = 12.288MHz Default settings used. PLL Disabled I2S Interface with 16bit Word Length. AOSR 128 PRB_R1 PTM_R4 w w w w w w w w w w w w w w w w w 30 30 30 30 30 30 30 30 30 30 30 30 30 30 30 30 30 00 01 12 13 14 3d 00 01 02 0a 3d 47 7b 34 36 37 39 00 01 81 82 80 01 01 08 00 00 00 32 01 80 80 80 80 w 30 3b 0c w w w w 4.3 30 30 30 30 3c 00 51 52 0c 00 c0 00 # # # # # # # # # # # # # # # # # # # # # # # # Initialize to Page 0 S/W Reset to initialize all registers Power up NADC divider with value 1 Power up MADC divider with value 2 Program OSR for ADC to 128 Select ADC PRB_R1 Select Page 1 Disable Internal Crude AVdd in presence of external AVdd supply Enable Master Analog Power Control Set the input common mode to 0.9V Select ADC PTM_R4 Set MicPGA startup delay to 3.1ms Set the REF charging time to 40ms Route IN1L to LEFT_P with 20K input impedance Route Common Mode to LEFT_M with impedance of 20K Route IN1R to RIGHT_P with input impedance of 20K Route Common Mode to RIGHT_M with impedance of 20K Unmute Left MICPGA, Gain selection of 6dB to make channel gain 0dB Register of 6dB with input impedance of 20K => Channel Gain of 0dB Unmute Right MICPGA, Gain selection of 6dB to make channel gain 0dB Register of 6dB with input impedance of 20K => Channel Gain of 0dB Select Page 0 Power up Left and Right ADC Channels Unmute Left and Right ADC Digital Volume Control Stereo ADC with 48ksps Sample Rate and Low Power Assumption AVdd = 1.8V, DVdd = 1.8V, I2S Interface with 16bit Word Length. w w w w w w w w w w w w w w w w w 30 30 30 30 30 30 30 30 30 30 30 30 30 30 30 30 30 00 01 12 13 14 3d 00 01 02 0a 3d 47 7b 34 36 37 39 00 01 81 84 40 07 01 08 00 40 ff 32 01 80 80 80 80 w 30 3b 0c w w w w 90 30 30 30 30 3c 00 51 52 0c 00 c0 00 Example Setups # # # # # # # # # # # # # # # # # # # # # # # # MCLK = 12.288MHz, Default settings used, PLL Disabled, Initialize to Page 0 S/W Reset to initialize all registers Power up NADC divider with value 1 Power up MADC divider with value 4 Program OSR for ADC to 64 Select ADC PRB_R7 Select Page 1 Disable Internal Crude AVdd in presence of external AVdd supply Enable Master Analog Power Control Set the input common mode to 0.75V Select ADC PTM_R1 Set MicPGA startup delay to 3.1ms Set the REF charging time to 40ms Route IN1L to LEFT_P with 20K input impedance Route Common Mode to LEFT_M with impedance of 20K Route IN1R to RIGHT_P with input impedance of 20K Route Common Mode to RIGHT_M with impedance of 20K Unmute Left MICPGA, Gain selection of 6dB to make channel gain 0dB Register of 6dB with input impedance of 20K => Channel Gain of 0dB Unmute Right MICPGA, Gain selection of 6dB to make channel gain 0dB Register of 6dB with input impedance of 20K => Channel Gain of 0dB Select Page 0 Power up Left and Right ADC Channels Unmute Left and Right ADC Digital Volume Control SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated Chapter 5 SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Register Map The TLV320AIC3206 contains 108 pages of 8-bit registers, each page can contain up to 128 registers. The register pages are divided up based on functional blocks for this device. Page 0 is the default home page after hardware reset. Topic 5.1 5.2 5.3 5.4 5.5 5.6 5.7 5.8 5.9 5.10 5.11 5.12 5.13 ........................................................................................................................... Page Register Map Summary ...................................................................................... 92 Page 0 Registers ............................................................................................... 95 Page 1 Registers ............................................................................................. 122 Page 8 Registers ............................................................................................. 139 Page 9-16 Registers ......................................................................................... 139 Page 26-34 Registers ....................................................................................... 140 Page 44 Registers ............................................................................................ 140 Page 45-52 Registers ....................................................................................... 141 Page 62-70 Registers ....................................................................................... 141 ADC Coefficients A+B ...................................................................................... 142 ADC Defaults .................................................................................................. 143 DAC Coefficients A+B ...................................................................................... 144 DAC Defaults .................................................................................................. 145 SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated Register Map 91 Register Map Summary 5.1 www.ti.com Register Map Summary Table 5-1. Summary of Register Map Decimal 92 Hex DESCRIPTION PAGE NO. REG. NO. PAGE NO. REG. NO. 0 0 0x00 0x00 Page Select Register 0 1 0x00 0x01 Software Reset Register 0 2 0x00 0x02 Reserved Register 0 3 0x00 0x03 Reserved Register 0 4 0x00 0x04 Clock Setting Register 1, Multiplexers 0 5 0x00 0x05 Clock Setting Register 2, PLL P&R Values 0 6 0x00 0x06 Clock Setting Register 3, PLL J Values 0 7 0x00 0x07 Clock Setting Register 4, PLL D Values (MSB) 0 8 0x00 0x08 Clock Setting Register 5, PLL D Values (LSB) 0 9-10 0x00 0x09-0x0A Reserved Register 0 11 0x00 0x0B Clock Setting Register 6, NDAC Values 0 12 0x00 0x0C Clock Setting Register 7, MDAC Values 0 13 0x00 0x0D DAC OSR Setting Register 1, MSB Value 0 14 0x00 0x0E DAC OSR Setting Register 2, LSB Value 0 15 0x00 0x0F Reserved Register 0 16 0x00 0x10 Reserved Register 0 17 0x00 0x11 Reserved Register 0 18 0x00 0x12 Clock Setting Register 8, NADC Values 0 19 0x00 0x13 Clock Setting Register 9, MADC Values 0 20 0x00 0x14 ADC Oversampling (AOSR) Register 0 21 0x00 0x15 Reserved Register 0 22 0x00 0x16 Reserved Register 0 23 0x00 0x17 Reserved Register 0 24 0x00 0x18 Reserved Register 0 25 0x00 0x19 Clock Setting Register 10, Multiplexers 0 26 0x00 0x1A Clock Setting Register 11, CLKOUT M divider value 0 27 0x00 0x1B Audio Interface Setting Register 1 0 28 0x00 0x1C Audio Interface Setting Register 2, Data offset setting 0 29 0x00 0x1D Audio Interface Setting Register 3 0 30 0x00 0x1E Clock Setting Register 12, BCLK N Divider 0 31 0x00 0x1F Audio Interface Setting Register 4, Secondary Audio Interface 0 32 0x00 0x20 Audio Interface Setting Register 5 0 33 0x00 0x21 Audio Interface Setting Register 6 0 34 0x00 0x22 Digital Interface Misc. Setting Register 0 35 0x00 0x23 Reserved Register 0 36 0x00 0x24 ADC Flag Register 0 37 0x00 0x25 DAC Flag Register 1 0 38 0x00 0x26 DAC Flag Register 2 0 39-41 0x00 0x27-0x29 Reserved Register 0 42 0x00 0x2A Sticky Flag Register 1 0 43 0x00 0x2B Interrupt Flag Register 1 0 44 0x00 0x2C Sticky Flag Register 2 0 45 0x00 0x2D Sticky Flag Register 3 0 46 0x00 0x2E Interrupt Flag Register 2 0 47 0x00 0x2F Interrupt Flag Register 3 Register Map SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated Register Map Summary www.ti.com Table 5-1. Summary of Register Map (continued) Decimal Hex DESCRIPTION PAGE NO. REG. NO. PAGE NO. REG. NO. 0 48 0x00 0x30 INT1 Interrupt Control Register 0 49 0x00 0x31 INT2 Interrupt Control Register 0 50-51 0x00 0x32-0x33 Reserved Register 0 52 0x00 0x34 GPIO/MFP5 Control Register 0 53 0x00 0x35 DOUT/MFP2 Function Control Register 0 54 0x00 0x36 DIN/MFP1 Function Control Register 0 55 0x00 0x37 MISO/MFP4 Function Control Register 0 56 0x00 0x38 SCLK/MFP3 Function Control Register 0 57-59 0x00 0x39-0x3B Reserved Registers 0 60 0x00 0x3C DAC Signal Processing Block Control Register 0 61 0x00 0x3D ADC Signal Processing Block Control Register 0 62 0x00 0x3E Reserved Register 0 63 0x00 0x3F DAC Channel Setup Register 1 0 64 0x00 0x40 DAC Channel Setup Register 2 0 65 0x00 0x41 Left DAC Channel Digital Volume Control Register 0 66 0x00 0x42 Right DAC Channel Digital Volume Control Register 0 67 0x00 0x43 Headset Detection Configuration Register 0 68 0x00 0x44 DRC Control Register 1 0 69 0x00 0x45 DRC Control Register 2 0 70 0x00 0x46 DRC Control Register 3 0 71 0x00 0x47 Beep Generator Register 1 0 72 0x00 0x48 Beep Generator Register 2 0 73 0x00 0x49 Beep Generator Register 3 0 74 0x00 0x4A Beep Generator Register 4 0 75 0x00 0x4B Beep Generator Register 5 0 76 0x00 0x4C Beep Generator Register 6 0 77 0x00 0x4D Beep Generator Register 7 0 78 0x00 0x4E Beep Generator Register 8 0 79 0x00 0x4F Beep Generator Register 9 0 80 0x00 0x50 Reserved Register 0 81 0x00 0x51 ADC Channel Setup Register 0 82 0x00 0x52 ADC Fine Gain Adjust Register 0 83 0x00 0x53 Left ADC Channel Volume Control Register 0 84 0x00 0x54 Right ADC Channel Volume Control Register 0 85 0x00 0x55 ADC Phase Adjust Register 0 86 0x00 0x56 Left Channel AGC Control Register 1 0 87 0x00 0x57 Left Channel AGC Control Register 2 0 88 0x00 0x58 Left Channel AGC Control Register 3 0 89 0x00 0x59 Left Channel AGC Control Register 4 0 90 0x00 0x5A Left Channel AGC Control Register 5 0 91 0x00 0x5B Left Channel AGC Control Register 6 0 92 0x00 0x5C Left Channel AGC Control Register 7 0 93 0x00 0x5D Left Channel AGC Control Register 8 0 94 0x00 0x5E Right Channel AGC Control Register 1 0 95 0x00 0x5F Right Channel AGC Control Register 2 0 96 0x00 0x60 Right Channel AGC Control Register 3 SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated Register Map 93 Register Map Summary www.ti.com Table 5-1. Summary of Register Map (continued) Decimal 94 Hex DESCRIPTION PAGE NO. REG. NO. PAGE NO. REG. NO. 0 97 0x00 0x61 Right Channel AGC Control Register 4 0 98 0x00 0x62 Right Channel AGC Control Register 5 0 99 0x00 0x63 Right Channel AGC Control Register 6 0 100 0x00 0x64 Right Channel AGC Control Register 7 0 101 0x00 0x65 Right Channel AGC Control Register 8 0 102 0x00 0x66 DC Measurement Register 1 0 103 0x00 0x67 DC Measurement Register 2 0 104 0x00 0x68 Left Channel DC Measurement Output Register 1 0 105 0x00 0x69 Left Channel DC Measurement Output Register 2 0 106 0x00 0x6A Left Channel DC Measurement Output Register 3 0 107 0x00 0x6B Right Channel DC Measurement Output Register 1 0 108 0x00 0x6C Right Channel DC Measurement Output Register 2 0 109 0x00 0x6D Right Channel DC Measurement Output Register 3 0 110-127 0x00 0x6E-0x7F Reserved Register 1 0 0x01 0x00 Page Select Register 1 1 0x01 0x01 Power Configuration Register 1 1 2 0x01 0x02 Power Configuration Register 2 1 3 0x01 0x03 Playback Configuration Register 1 1 4 0x01 0x04 Playback Configuration Register 2 1 5-8 0x01 0x05-0x08 Reserved Register 1 9 0x01 0x09 Output Driver Power Control Register 1 10 0x01 0x0A Common Mode Control Register 1 11 0x01 0x0B Over Current Protection Configuration Register 1 12 0x01 0x0C HPL Routing Selection Register 1 13 0x01 0x0D HPR Routing Selection Register 1 14 0x01 0x0E LOL Routing Selection Register 1 15 0x01 0x0F LOR Routing Selection Register 1 16 0x01 0x10 HPL Driver Gain Setting Register 1 17 0x01 0x11 HPR Driver Gain Setting Register 1 18 0x01 0x12 LOL Driver Gain Setting Register 1 19 0x01 0x13 LOR Driver Gain Setting Register 1 20 0x01 0x14 Headphone Driver Startup Control Register 1 21 0x01 0x15 Reserved Register 1 22 0x01 0x16 IN1L to HPL Volume Control Register 1 23 0x01 0x17 IN1R to HPR Volume Control Register 1 24 0x01 0x18 Mixer Amplifier Left Volume Control Register 1 25 0x01 0x19 Mixer Amplifier Right Volume Control Register 1 26-50 0x01 0x1A-0x32 Reserved Register 1 51 0x01 0x33 MICBIAS Configuration Register 1 52 0x01 0x34 Left MICPGA Positive Terminal Input Routing Configuration Register 1 53 0x01 0x35 Reserved Register 1 54 0x01 0x36 Left MICPGA Negative Terminal Input Routing Configuration Register 1 55 0x01 0x37 Right MICPGA Positive Terminal Input Routing Configuration Register 1 56 0x01 0x38 Reserved Register 1 57 0x01 0x39 Right MICPGA Negative Terminal Input Routing Configuration Register 1 58 0x01 0x3A Floating Input Configuration Register Register Map SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated Page 0 Registers www.ti.com Table 5-1. Summary of Register Map (continued) Decimal 5.2 Hex DESCRIPTION PAGE NO. REG. NO. PAGE NO. REG. NO. 1 59 0x01 0x3B Left MICPGA Volume Control Register 1 60 0x01 0x3C Right MICPGA Volume Control Register 1 61 0x01 0x3D ADC Power Tune Configuration Register 1 62 0x01 0x3E ADC Analog Volume Control Flag Register 1 63 0x01 0x3F DAC Analog Gain Control Flag Register 1 64-70 0x01 0x40-0x46 Reserved Register 1 71 0x01 0x47 Analog Input Quick Charging Configuration Register 1 72-122 0x01 0x48-0x7A Reserved Register 1 123 0x01 0x7B Reference Power-up Configuration Register 1 124 0x01 0x7C Charge Pump Control Register 1 125 0x01 0x7D Headphone Driver Configuration Register 1 126-127 0x01 0x7E-0x7F Reserved Register 8 0 0x08 0x00 Page Select Register 8 1 0x08 0x01 ADC Adaptive Filter Configuration Register 8 1-7 0x08 0x01-0x07 Reserved 8 8-127 0x08 0x08-0x7F ADC Coefficients Buffer-A C(0:29) 9-16 0 0x09-0x10 0x00 Page Select Register 9-16 1-7 0x09-0x10 0x01-0x07 Reserved 9-16 8-127 0x09-0x10 0x08-0x7F ADC Coefficients Buffer-A C(30:255) 26-34 0 0x1A-0x22 0x00 Page Select Register 26-34 1-7 0x1A-0x22 0x01-0x07 Reserved. 26-34 8-127 0x1A-0x22 0x08-0x7F ADC Coefficients Buffer-B C(0:255) 44 0 0x2C 0x00 Page Select Register 44 1 0x2C 0x01 DAC Adaptive Filter Configuration Register 44 2-7 0x2C 0x02-0x07 Reserved 44 8-127 0x2C 0x08-0x7F DAC Coefficients Buffer-A C(0:29) 45-52 0 0x2D-0x34 0x00 Page Select Register 45-52 1-7 0x2D-0x34 0x01-0x07 Reserved. 45-52 8-127 0x2D-0x34 0x08-0x7F DAC Coefficients Buffer-A C(30:255) 62-70 0 0x3E-0x46 0x00 Page Select Register 62-70 1-7 0x3E-0x46 0x01-0x07 Reserved. 62-70 8-127 0x3E-0x46 0x08-0x7F DAC Coefficients Buffer-B C(0:255) Page 0 Registers 5.2.1 Page 0 / Register 0: Page Select Register - 0x00 / 0x00 BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7-D0 R/W 0000 0000 5.2.2 DESCRIPTION Page Select Register 0-255: Selects the Register Page for next read or write command. Refer Table "Summary of Memory Map" for details. Page 0 / Register 1: Software Reset Register - 0x00 / 0x01 BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7-D1 R 0000 000 DESCRIPTION Reserved, Write only default values SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated Register Map 95 Page 0 Registers www.ti.com Page 0 / Register 1: Software Reset Register - 0x00 / 0x01 (continued) BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D0 W 0 5.2.3 Self clearing software reset bit 0: Don't care 1: Self clearing software reset Page 0 / Register 2: Reserved Register - 0x00 / 0x02 BIT READ/ WRITE D7-D0 R 5.2.4 RESET VALUE DESCRIPTION 0XXX 0XXX Reserved, Write only default values Page 0 / Register 3: Reserved Register - 0x00 / 0x03 BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7-D0 R 0000 0000 5.2.5 DESCRIPTION Reserved, Write only default values to this register Page 0 / Register 4: Clock Setting Register 1, Multiplexers - 0x00 / 0x04 READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7 R 0 Reserved, Write only default values D6 R/W 0 Select PLL Range 0: Low PLL Clock Range 1: High PLL Clock Range D5-D4 R 00 Reserved, Write only default values D3-D2 R/W 00 Select PLL Input Clock 00: MCLK pin is input to PLL 01: BCLK pin is input to PLL 10: GPIO pin is input to PLL 11: DIN pin is input to PLL D1-D0 R/W 00 Select CODEC_CLKIN 00: MCLK pin is CODEC_CLKIN 01: BCLK pin is CODEC_CLKIN 10: GPIO pin is CODEC_CLKIN 11: PLL Clock is CODEC_CLKIN BIT 5.2.6 96 DESCRIPTION DESCRIPTION Page 0 / Register 5: Clock Setting Register 2, PLL P&R Values - 0x00 / 0x05 BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7 R/W 0 D6-D4 R/W 001 PLL divider P Value 000: P=8 001: P=1 010: P=2 … 110: P=6 111: P=7 D3-D0 R/W 0001 PLL divider R Value 000: Reserved, do not use 001: R=1 010: R=2 011: R=3 100: R=4 101…111: Reserved, do not use Register Map DESCRIPTION PLL Power Up 0: PLL is powered down 1: PLL is powered up SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated Page 0 Registers www.ti.com 5.2.7 Page 0 / Register 6: Clock Setting Register 3, PLL J Values - 0x00 / 0x06 BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7-D6 R 00 D5-D0 R/W 00 0100 5.2.8 READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7-D6 R 00 D5-D0 R/W 00 0000 READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7-D0 R/W 0000 0000 DESCRIPTION Reserved. Write only default values PLL divider D value (MSB) PLL divider D value(MSB) & PLL divider D value(LSB) 00 0000 0000 0000: D=0000 00 0000 0000 0001: D=0001 … 10 0111 0000 1110: D=9998 10 0111 0000 1111: D=9999 10 0111 0001 0000…11 1111 1111 1111: Do not use Note: This register will be updated only when the Page-0, Reg-8 is written immediately after Page0, Reg-7 DESCRIPTION PLL divider D value (LSB) PLL divider D value(MSB) & PLL divider D value(LSB) 00 0000 0000 0000: D=0000 00 0000 0000 0001: D=0001 … 10 0111 0000 1110: D=9998 10 0111 0000 1111: D=9999 10 0111 0001 0000…11 1111 1111 1111: Do not use Note: Page-0, Reg-8 should be written immediately after Page-0, Reg-7 Page 0 / Register 9-10: Reserved Register - 0x00 / 0x09-0x0A BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7-D0 R 0000 0000 5.2.11 PLL divider J value 00 0000…00 0011: Do not use 00 0100: J=4 00 0101: J=5 … 11 1110: J=62 11 1111: J=63 Page 0 / Register 8: Clock Setting Register 5, PLL D Values (LSB) - 0x00 / 0x08 BIT 5.2.10 Reserved. Write only default values Page 0 / Register 7: Clock Setting Register 4, PLL D Values (MSB) - 0x00 / 0x07 BIT 5.2.9 DESCRIPTION DESCRIPTION Reserved, Write only default values. Page 0 / Register 11: Clock Setting Register 6, NDAC Values - 0x00 / 0x0B BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7 R/W 0 D6-D0 R/W 000 0001 DESCRIPTION NDAC Divider Power Control 0: NDAC divider powered down 1: NDAC divider powered up NDAC Value 000 0000: NDAC=128 000 0001: NDAC=1 000 0010: NDAC=2 … 111 1110: NDAC=126 111 1111: NDAC=127 Note: Please check the clock frequency requirements in the Overview section SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated Register Map 97 Page 0 Registers 5.2.12 Page 0 / Register 12: Clock Setting Register 7, MDAC Values - 0x00 / 0x0C BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7 R/W 0 D6-D0 R/W 000 0001 5.2.13 RESET VALUE D7-D2 R 0000 00 D1-D0 R/W 00 5.2.14 READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7-D0 R/W 1000 0000 READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7-D0 R 0000 0010 DESCRIPTION Reserved. Write only default values DAC OSR (DOSR) Setting DAC OSR(MSB) & DAC OSR(LSB) 00 0000 0000: DOSR=1024 00 0000 0001: Reserved. Do not use 00 0000 0010: DOSR=2 … 11 1111 1110: DOSR=1022 11 1111 1111: Reserved. Do not use Note: This register is updated when Page-0, Reg-14 is written to immediately after Page-0, Reg-13 Note: DOSR should be a multiple of 2 while using DAC Filter Type A, Multiple of 4 while using DAC Filter Type B and Multiple of 8 while using DAC Filter Type C DESCRIPTION DAC OSR (DOSR) Setting DAC OSR(MSB) & DAC OSR(LSB) 00 0000 0000: DOSR=1024 00 0000 0001: Reserved. Do not use 00 0000 0010: DOSR=2 … 11 1111 1110: DOSR=1022 11 1111 1111: Reserved. Do not use Note: This register should be written immediately after Page-0, Reg-13 Note: DOSR should be a multiple of 2 while using DAC Filter Type A, Multiple of 4 while using DAC Filter Type B and Multiple of 8 while using DAC Filter Type C DESCRIPTION Reserved. Write only default values Page 0 / Register 16: Reserved Register - 0x00 / 0x10 BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7-D0 R/W 0000 0000 5.2.17 MDAC Value 000 0000: MDAC=128 000 0001: MDAC=1 000 0010: MDAC=2 … 111 1110: MDAC=126 111 1111: MDAC=127 Note: Please check the clock frequency requirements in the Overview section Page 0 / Register 15: Reserved Register - 0x00 / 0x0F BIT 5.2.16 MDAC Divider Power Control 0: MDAC divider powered down 1: MDAC divider powered up Page 0 / Register 14: DAC OSR Setting Register 2, LSB Value - 0x00 / 0x0E BIT 5.2.15 DESCRIPTION Page 0 / Register 13: DAC OSR Setting Register 1, MSB Value - 0x00 / 0x0D READ/ WRITE BIT 98 www.ti.com DESCRIPTION Reserved. Write only default values Page 0 / Register 17: Reserved Register - 0x00 / 0x11 BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7-D0 R 0000 1000 Register Map DESCRIPTION Reserved. Write only default values SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated Page 0 Registers www.ti.com 5.2.18 Page 0 / Register 18: Clock Setting Register 8, NADC Values - 0x00 / 0x12 BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7 R/W 0 D6-D0 R/W 000 0001 5.2.19 READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7 R/W 0 D6-D0 R/W 000 0001 READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7-D0 R/W 1000 0000 READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7-D0 R 0000 0001 READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7-D0 R 0000 0000 MADC Value 000 0000: MADC=128 000 0001: MADC=1 … 111 1110: MADC=126 111 1111: MADC=127 Note: Please check the clock frequency requirements in the application overview section DESCRIPTION ADC Oversampling Value 0000 0000: ADC AOSR = 256 0000 0001-0001 1111: Reserved. Do not use 0010 0000: ADC AOSR=32 (Use with PRB_R13 to PRB_R18, ADC Filter Type C) 0010 0001-0011 1111: Reserved.Do not use 0100 0000: AOSR=64 (Use with PRB_R1 to PRB_R12, ADC Filter Type A or B) 0100 0001-0111 1111: Reserved. Do not use 1000 0000: AOSR=128(Use with PRB_R1 to PRB_R6, ADC Filter Type A) 1000 0001-1111 1111: Reserved. Do not use DESCRIPTION Reserved. Write only default values DESCRIPTION Reserved. Write only default values Page 0 / Register 23: Reserved Register - 0x00 / 0x17 BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7-D0 R 0000 0100 5.2.24 MADC Clock Divider Power Control 0: MADC divider powered down, ADC_MOD_CLK is same as DAC_MOD_CLK 1: MADC divider powered up Page 0 / Register 22: Reserved Register - 0x00 / 0x16 BIT 5.2.23 DESCRIPTION Page 0 / Register 21: Reserved Register - 0x00 / 0x15 BIT 5.2.22 NADC Value 000 0000: NADC=128 000 0001: NADC=1 … 111 1110: NADC=126 111 1111: NADC=127 Note: Please check the clock frequency requirements in the application overview section Page 0 / Register 20: ADC Oversampling (AOSR) Register - 0x00 / 0x14 BIT 5.2.21 NADC Clock Divider Power Control 0: NADC divider powered down, ADC_CLK is same as DAC_CLK 1: NADC divider powered up Page 0 / Register 19: Clock Setting Register 9, MADC Values - 0x00 / 0x13 BIT 5.2.20 DESCRIPTION DESCRIPTION Reserved. Write only default values Page 0 / Register 24: Reserved Register - 0x00 / 0x18 BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7-D0 R 0000 0000 DESCRIPTION Reserved. Write only default values SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated Register Map 99 Page 0 Registers 5.2.25 www.ti.com Page 0 / Register 25: Clock Setting Register 10, Multiplexers - 0x00 / 0x19 BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7-D3 R 0000 0 Reserved. Write only default values D2-D0 R/W 000 CDIV_CLKIN Clock Selection 000: CDIV_CLKIN= MCLK 001: CDIV_CLKIN= BCLK 010: CDIV_CLKIN=DIN 011: CDIV_CLKIN=PLL_CLK 100: CDIV_CLKIN=DAC_CLK 101: CDIV_CLKIN=DAC_MOD_CLK 110: CDIV_CLKIN=ADC_CLK 111: CDIV_CLKIN=ADC_MOD_CLK 5.2.26 Page 0 / Register 26: Clock Setting Register 11, CLKOUT M divider value - 0x00 / 0x1A BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7 R/W 0 D6-D0 R/W 000 0001 5.2.27 DESCRIPTION DESCRIPTION CLKOUT M divider power control 0: CLKOUT M divider powered down 1: CLKOUT M divider powered up CLKOUT M divider value 000 0000: CLKOUT M divider = 128 000 0001: CLKOUT M divider = 1 000 0010: CLKOUT M divider = 2 … 111 1110: CLKOUT M divider = 126 111 1111: CLKOUT M divider = 127 Note: Please check the clock frequency requirements in the application overview section Page 0 / Register 27: Audio Interface Setting Register 1 - 0x00 / 0x1B BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7-D6 R/W 00 Audio Interface Selection 00: Audio Interface = I2S 01: Audio Interface = DSP 10: Audio Interface = RJF 11: Audio Interface = LJF D5-D4 R/W 00 Audio Data Word length 00: Data Word length = 16 01: Data Word length = 20 10: Data Word length = 24 11: Data Word length = 32 bits bits bits bits D3 R/W 0 BCLK Direction Control 0: BCLK is input to the device 1: BCLK is output from the device D2 R/W 0 WCLK Direction Control 0: WCLK is input to the device 1: WCLK is output from the device D1 R 0 Reserved. Write only default values D0 R/W 0 DOUT High Impendance Output Control 0: DOUT will not be high impedance while Audio Interface is active 1: DOUT will be high impedance after data has been transferred 5.2.28 Page 0 / Register 28: Audio Interface Setting Register 2, Data offset setting - 0x00 / 0x1C BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7-D0 R/W 0000 0000 100 DESCRIPTION Register Map DESCRIPTION Data Offset Value 0000 0000: Data Offset = 0 BCLK's 0000 0001: Data Offset = 1 BCLK's … 1111 1110: Data Offset = 254 BCLK's 1111 1111: Data Offset = 255 BCLK's SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated Page 0 Registers www.ti.com 5.2.29 Page 0 / Register 29: Audio Interface Setting Register 3 - 0x00 / 0x1D BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7-D6 R/W 00 Reserved. Write only default values D5 R/W 0 Loopback control 0: No Loopback 1: Audio Data in is routed to Audio Data out D4 R/W 0 Loopback control 0: No Loopback 1: Stereo ADC output is routed to Stereo DAC input D3 R/W 0 Audio Bit Clock Polarity Control 0: Default Bit Clock polarity 1: Bit Clock is inverted w.r.t. default polarity D2 R/W 0 Primary BCLK and Primary WCLK Power control 0: Priamry BCLK and Primary WCLK buffers are powered down when the codec is powered down 1: Primary BCLK and Primary WCLK buffers are powered up when they are used in clock generation even when the codec is powered down D1-D0 R/W 00 BDIV_CLKIN Multiplexer Control 00: BDIV_CLKIN = DAC_CLK 01: BDIV_CLKIN = DAC_MOD_CLK 10: BDIV_CLKIN = ADC_CLK 11: BDIV_CLKIN = ADC_MOD_CLK 5.2.30 Page 0 / Register 30: Clock Setting Register 12, BCLK N Divider - 0x00 / 0x1E BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7 R/W 0 D6-D0 R/W 000 0001 5.2.31 BIT DESCRIPTION DESCRIPTION BCLK N Divider Power Control 0: BCLK N divider powered down 1: BCLK N divider powered up BCLK N Divider value 0000 0000: BCLK N divider 0000 0001: BCLK N divider … 1111 1110: BCLK N divider 1111 1111: BCLK N divider = 128 =1 = 126 = 127 Page 0 / Register 31: Audio Interface Setting Register 4, Secondary Audio Interface 0x00 / 0x1F READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE DESCRIPTION D7 R 0 Reserved. Write only default values D6-D5 R/W 00 Secondary Bit Clock Multiplexer 00: Secondary Bit Clock = GPIO 01: Secondary Bit Clock = SCLK 10: Secondary Bit Clock = MISO 11: Secondary Bit Clock = DOUT D4-D3 R/W 00 Secondary Word Clock Multiplexer 00: Secondary Word Clock = GPIO 01: Secondary Word Clock = SCLK 10: Secondary Word Clock = MISO 11: Secondary Word Clock = DOUT D2-D1 R/W 00 ADC Word Clock Multiplexer 00: ADC Word Clock = GPIO 01: ADC Word Clock = SCLK 10: ADC Word Clock = MISO 11: Do not use D0 R/W 0 Secondary Data Input Multiplexer 0: Secondary Data Input = GPIO 1: Secondary Data Input = SCLK SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated Register Map 101 Page 0 Registers 5.2.32 www.ti.com Page 0 / Register 32: Audio Interface Setting Register 5 - 0x00 / 0x20 BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7-D4 R 0000 D3 R/W 0 Primary / Secondary Bit Clock Control 0: Primary Bit Clock(BCLK) is used for Audio Interface and Clocking 1: Secondary Bit Clock is used for Audio Interface and Clocking D2 R/W 0 Primary / Secondary Word Clock Control 0: Primary Word Clock(WCLK) is used for Audio Interface 1: Secondary Word Clock is used for Audio Interface D1 R/W 0 ADC Word Clock Control 0: ADC Word Clock is same as DAC Word Clock 1: ADC Word Clock is Secondary ADC Word Clock D0 R/W 0 Audio Data In Control 0: DIN is used for Audio Data In 1: Secondary Data In is used for Audio Data In 5.2.33 DESCRIPTION Reserved. Write only default values Page 0 / Register 33: Audio Interface Setting Register 6 - 0x00 / 0x21 BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7 R/W 0 BCLK Output Control 0: BCLK Output = Generated Primary Bit Clock 1: BCLK Output = Secondary Bit Clock Input D6 R/W 0 Secondary Bit Clock Output Control 0: Secondary Bit Clock = BCLK input 1: Secondary Bit Clock = Generated Primary Bit Clock D5-D4 R/W 00 WCLK Output Control 00: WCLK Output = Generated DAC_FS 01: WCLK Output = Generated ADC_FS 10: WCLK Output = Secondary Word Clock Input 11: Reserved. Do not use D3-D2 R/W 00 Secondary Word Clock Output Control 00: Secondary Word Clock output = WCLK input 01: Secondary Word Clock output = Generated DAC_FS 10: Secondary Word Clock output = Generated ADC_FS 11: Reserved. Do not use D1 R/W 0 Primary Data Out output control 0: DOUT output = Data Output from Serial Interface 1: DOUT output = Secondary Data Input (Loopback) D0 R/W 0 Secondary Data Out output control 0: Secondary Data Output = DIN input (Loopback) 1: Secondary Data Output = Data output from Serial Interface 5.2.34 DESCRIPTION Page 0 / Register 34: Digital Interface Misc. Setting Register - 0x00 / 0x22 BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7 R 0 Reserved. Write only default values D6 R 0 Reserved. Write only default values D5 R/W 0 I2C General Call Address Configuration 0: I2C General Call Address will be ignored 1: I2C General Call Address accepted D4-D0 R 0 0000 5.2.35 Reserved. Write only default values Page 0 / Register 35: Reserved Register - 0x00 / 0x23 BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7-D0 R 0000 0000 102 DESCRIPTION Register Map DESCRIPTION Reserved. Write only default values SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated Page 0 Registers www.ti.com 5.2.36 Page 0 / Register 36: ADC Flag Register - 0x00 / 0x24 BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7 R 0 Left ADC PGA Status Flag 0: Gain Applied in Left ADC PGA is not equal to Programmed Gain in Control Register 1: Gain Applied in Left ADC PGA is equal to Programmed Gain in Control Register D6 R 0 Left ADC Power Status Flag 0: Left ADC Powered Down 1: Left ADC Powered Up D5 R 0 Left AGC Gain Status. This sticky flag will self clear on reading 0: Gain in Left AGC is not saturated 1: Gain in Left ADC is equal to maximum allowed gain in Left AGC D4 R 0 Reserved. Write only default values D3 R 0 Right ADC PGA Status Flag 0: Gain Applied in Right ADC PGA is not equal to Programmed Gain in Control Register 1: Gain Applied in Right ADC PGA is equal to Programmed Gain in Control Register D2 R 0 Right ADC Power Status Flag 0: Right ADC Powered Down 1: Right ADC Powered Up D1 R 0 Right AGC Gain Status. This sticky flag will self clear on reading 0: Gain in Right AGC is not saturated 1: Gain in Right ADC is equal to maximum allowed gain in Right AGC D0 R 0 Reserved. Write only default values 5.2.37 DESCRIPTION Page 0 / Register 37: DAC Flag Register 1 - 0x00 / 0x25 BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7 R 0 Left DAC Power Status Flag 0: Left DAC Powered Down 1: Left DAC Powered Up D6 R 0 Left Line Output Driver(LOL) Power Status Flag 0: LOL Powered Down 1: LOL Powered Up D5 R 0 Left Headphone Driver (HPL) Power Status Flag 0: HPL Powered Down 1: HPL Powered Up D4 R 0 Reserved. Write only default values D3 R 0 Right DAC Power Status Flag 0: Right DAC Powered Down 1: Right DAC Powered Up D2 R 0 Right Line Output Driver(LOR) Power Status Flag 0: LOR Powered Down 1: LOR Powered Up D1 R 0 Right Headphone Driver (HPR) Power Status Flag 0: HPR Powered Down 1: HPR Powered Up D0 R 0 Reserved. Write only default values 5.2.38 DESCRIPTION Page 0 / Register 38: DAC Flag Register 2 - 0x00 / 0x26 BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7-D5 R 000 D4 R 0 D3-D1 R 000 D0 R 0 DESCRIPTION Reserved. Write only default values Left DAC PGA Status Flag 0: Gain applied in Left DAC PGA is not equal to Gain programmed in Control Register 1: Gain applied in Left DAC PGA is equal to Gain programmed in Control Register Reserved. Write only default values Right DAC PGA Status Flag 0: Gain applied in Right DAC PGA is not equal to Gain programmed in Control Register 1: Gain applied in Right DAC PGA is equal to Gain programmed in Control Register SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated Register Map 103 Page 0 Registers 5.2.39 www.ti.com Page 0 / Register 39-41: Reserved Register - 0x00 / 0x27-0x29 BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7-D0 R 0000 0000 5.2.40 DESCRIPTION Reserved. Write only default values Page 0 / Register 42: Sticky Flag Register 1 - 0x00 / 0x2A BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7 R 0 Left DAC Overflow Status. This sticky flag will self clear on read 0: No overflow in Left DAC 1: Overflow has happened in Left DAC since last read of this register D6 R 0 Right DAC Overflow Status. This sticky flag will self clear on read 0: No overflow in Right DAC 1: Overflow has happened in Right DAC since last read of this register D5-D4 R 00 Reserved. Write only default values D3 R 0 Left ADC Overflow Status. This sticky flag will self clear on read 0: No overflow in Left ADC 1: Overflow has happened in Left ADC since last read of this register D2 R 0 Right ADC Overflow Status. This sticky flag will self clear on read 0: No overflow in Right ADC 1: Overflow has happened in Right ADC since last read of this register D1-D0 R 00 Reserved. Write only default values 5.2.41 DESCRIPTION Page 0 / Register 43: Interrupt Flag Register 1 - 0x00 / 0x2B BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7 R 0 Left DAC Overflow Status. 0: No overflow in Left DAC 1: Overflow condition is present in Left ADC at the time of reading the register D6 R 0 Right DAC Overflow Status. 0: No overflow in Right DAC 1: Overflow condition is present in Right DAC at the time of reading the register D5-D4 R 00 Reserved. Write only default values D3 R 0 Left ADC Overflow Status. 0: No overflow in Left ADC 1: Overflow condition is present in Left ADC at the time of reading the register D2 R 0 Right ADC Overflow Status. 0: No overflow in Right ADC 1: Overflow condition is present in Right ADC at the time of reading the register D1-D0 R 0 Reserved. Write only default values 5.2.42 104 DESCRIPTION Page 0 / Register 44: Sticky Flag Register 2 - 0x00 / 0x2C BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7 R 0 HPL Over Current Detect Flag 0: Over Current not detected on HPL 1: Over Current detected on HPL (will be cleared when the register is read) D6 R 0 HPR Over Current Detect Flag 0: Over Current not detected on HPR 1: Over Current detected on HPR (will be cleared when the register is read) D5 R 0 Headset Button Press 0: Button Press not detected 1: Button Press detected (will be cleared when the register is read) D4 R 0 Headset Insertion/Removal Detect Flag 0: Insertion/Removal event not detected 1: Insertion/Removal event detected (will be cleared when the register is read) D3 R 0 Left Channel DRC, Signal Threshold Flag 0: Signal Power is below Signal Threshold 1: Signal Power exceeded Signal Threshold (will be cleared when the register is read) Register Map DESCRIPTION SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated Page 0 Registers www.ti.com Page 0 / Register 44: Sticky Flag Register 2 - 0x00 / 0x2C (continued) BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D2 R 0 Right Channel DRC, Signal Threshold Flag 0: Signal Power is below Signal Threshold 1: Signal Power exceeded Signal Threshold (will be cleared when the register is read) D1-D0 R 00 Reserved. Write only default values 5.2.43 DESCRIPTION Page 0 / Register 45: Sticky Flag Register 3 - 0x00 / 0x2D BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7 R 0 Reserved. Write only default values D6 R 0 Left AGC Noise Threshold Flag 0: Signal Power is greater than Noise Threshold 1: Signal Power was lower than Noise Threshold (will be cleared when the register is read) D5 R 0 Right AGC Noise Threshold Flag 0: Signal Power is greater than Noise Threshold 1: Signal Power was lower than Noise Threshold (will be cleared when the register is read) D4-D3 R 00 Reserved. Write only default values D2 R 0 Left ADC DC Measurement Data Available Flag 0: Data not available 1: Data available (will be cleared when the register is read) D1 R 0 Right ADC DC Measurement Data Available Flag 0: Data not available 1: Data available (will be cleared when the register is read) D0 R 0 Reserved. Write only default values 5.2.44 DESCRIPTION Page 0 / Register 46: Interrupt Flag Register 2 - 0x00 / 0x2E BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7 R 0 HPL Over Current Detect Flag 0: Over Current not detected on HPL 1: Over Current detected on HPL D6 R 0 HPR Over Current Detect Flag 0: Over Current not detected on HPR 1: Over Current detected on HPR D5 R 0 Headset Button Press 0: Button Press not detected 1: Button Press detected D4 R 0 Headset Insertion/Removal Detect Flag 0: Headset removal detected 1: Headset insertion detected D3 R 0 Left Channel DRC, Signal Threshold Flag 0: Signal Power is below Signal Threshold 1: Signal Power exceeded Signal Threshold D2 R 0 Right Channel DRC, Signal Threshold Flag 0: Signal Power is below Signal Threshold 1: Signal Power exceeded Signal Threshold D1-D0 R 00 Reserved. Write only default values 5.2.45 DESCRIPTION Page 0 / Register 47: Interrupt Flag Register 3 - 0x00 / 0x2F BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7 R 0 Reserved. Write only default values D6 R 0 Left AGC Noise Threshold Flag 0: Signal Power is greater than Noise Threshold 1: Signal Power was lower than Noise Threshold DESCRIPTION SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated Register Map 105 Page 0 Registers www.ti.com Page 0 / Register 47: Interrupt Flag Register 3 - 0x00 / 0x2F (continued) BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D5 R 0 Right AGC Noise Threshold Flag 0: Signal Power is greater than Noise Threshold 1: Signal Power was lower than Noise Threshold D4-D3 R 00 Reserved. Write only default values D2 R 0 Left ADC DC Measurement Data Available Flag 0: Data not available 1: Data available D1 R 0 Right ADC DC Measurement Data Available Flag 0: Data not available 1: Data available D0 R 0 Reserved. Write only default values 5.2.46 Page 0 / Register 48: INT1 Interrupt Control Register - 0x00 / 0x30 BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7 R/W 0 INT1 Interrupt for Headset Insertion Event 0: Headset Insertion event will not generate a INT1 interrupt 1: Headset Insertion even will generate a INT1 interrupt D6 R/W 0 INT1 Interrupt for Button Press Event 0: Button Press event will not generate a INT1 interrupt 1: Button Press event will generate a INT1 interrupt D5 R/W 0 INT1 Interrupt for DAC DRC Signal Threshold 0: DAC DRC Signal Power exceeding Signal Threshold will not generate a INT1 interrupt 1: DAC DRC Signal Power exceeding Signal Threshold for either of Left or Right Channel will generate a INT1 interrupt. Read Page-0, Register-44 to distinguish between Left or Right Channel D4 R/W 0 INT1 Interrupt for AGC Noise Interrupt 0: Noise level detected by AGC will not generate a INT1 interrupt 1: Noise level detected by either off Left or Right Channel AGC will generate a INT1 interrupt. Read Page-0, Register-45 to distinguish between Left or Right Channel D3 R/W 0 INT1 Interrupt for Over Current Condition 0: Headphone Over Current condition will not generate a INT1 interrupt. 1: Headphone Over Current condition on either off Left or Right Channels will generate a INT1 interrupt. Read Page-0, Register-44 to distinguish between HPL and HPR D2 R/W 0 INT1 Interrupt for overflow event 0: ADC or DAC data overflows does not result in a INT1 interrupt 1: ADC or DAC data overflow will result in a INT1 interrupt. Read Page-0, Register-42 to distinguish between ADC or DAC data overflow D1 R/W 0 INT1 Interrupt for DC Measurement 0: DC Measurement data available will not generate INT1 interrupt 1: DC Measurement data available will generate INT1 interrupt D0 R/W 0 INT1 pulse control 0: INT1 is active high interrupt of 1 pulse of approx. 2ms duration 1: INT1 is active high interrupt of multiple pulses, each of duration 2ms. To stop the pulse train, read Page-0, Reg-42d, 44d or 45d 5.2.47 106 DESCRIPTION DESCRIPTION Page 0 / Register 49: INT2 Interrupt Control Register - 0x00 / 0x31 BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7 R/W 0 INT2 Interrupt for Headset Insertion Event 0: Headset Insertion event will not generate a INT2 interrupt 1: Headset Insertion even will generate a INT2 interrupt D6 R/W 0 INT2 Interrupt for Button Press Event 0: Button Press event will not generate a INT2 interrupt 1: Button Press event will generate a INT2 interrupt Register Map DESCRIPTION SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated Page 0 Registers www.ti.com Page 0 / Register 49: INT2 Interrupt Control Register - 0x00 / 0x31 (continued) BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D5 R/W 0 INT2 Interrupt for DAC DRC Signal Threshold 0: DAC DRC Signal Power exceeding Signal Threshold will not generate a INT2 interrupt 1: DAC DRC Signal Power exceeding Signal Threshold for either of Left or Right Channel will generate a INT2 interrupt. Read Page-0, Register-44 to distinguish between Left or Right Channel D4 R/W 0 INT2 Interrupt for AGC Noise Interrupt 0: Noise level detected by AGC will not generate a INT2 interrupt 1: Noise level detected by either off Left or Right Channel AGC will generate a INT2 interrupt. Read Page-0, Register-45 to distinguish between Left or Right Channel D3 R/W 0 INT2 Interrupt for Over Current Condition 0: Headphone Over Current condition will not generate a INT2 interrupt. 1: Headphone Over Current condition on either off Left or Right Channels will generate a INT2 interrupt. Read Page-0, Register-44 to distinguish between HPL and HPR D2 R/W 0 INT2 Interrupt for overflow event 0: ADC or DAC data overflow will not result in a INT2 interrupt 1: ADC or DAC data overflow will result in a INT2 interrupt. Read Page-0, Register-42 to distinguish between ADC or DAC data overflow D1 R/W 0 INT2 Interrupt for DC Measurement 0: DC Measurement data available will not generate INT2 interrupt 1: DC Measurement data available will generate INT2 interrupt D0 R/W 0 INT2 pulse control 0: INT2 is active high interrupt of 1 pulse of approx. 2ms duration 1: INT2 is active high interrupt of multiple pulses, each of duration 2ms. To stop the pulse train, read Page-0, Reg-42d, 44d and 45d 5.2.48 Page 0 / Register 50-51: Reserved Register - 0x00 / 0x32-0x33 BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7-D0 R 0000 0000 5.2.49 DESCRIPTION DESCRIPTION Reserved. Write only default values Page 0 / Register 52: GPIO/MFP5 Control Register - 0x00 / 0x34 BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7-D6 R 00 D5-D2 R/W 0000 D1 R X GPIO Input Pin state, used along with GPIO as general purpose input D0 R/W 0 GPIO as general purpose output control 0: GPIO pin is driven to '0' in general purpose output mode 1: GPIO pin is driven to '1' in general purpose output mode 5.2.50 DESCRIPTION Reserved. Write only default values GPIO Control 0000: GPIO input/output disabled. 0001: GPIO input is used for secondary audio interface, digital microphone input or clock input. Configure other registers to choose the functionality of GPIO input 0010: GPIO is general purpose input 0011: GPIO is general purpose output 0100: GPIO output is CLKOUT 0101: GPIO output is INT1 0110: GPIO output is INT2 0111: GPIO output is ADC_WCLK for Audio Interface 1000: GPIO output is secondary bit-clock for Audio Interface 1001: GPIO output is secondary word-clock for Audio Interface 1010: GPIO output is clock for digital microphone 1011-1111: Reserved. Do not use. Page 0 / Register 53: DOUT/MFP2 Function Control Register - 0x00 / 0x35 BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7-D5 R 000 DESCRIPTION Reserved. Write only default values SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated Register Map 107 Page 0 Registers www.ti.com Page 0 / Register 53: DOUT/MFP2 Function Control Register - 0x00 / 0x35 (continued) BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D4 R/W 1 D3-D1 R/W 001 DOUT MUX Control 000: DOUT disabled 001: DOUT is Primary DOUT 010: DOUT is General Purpose Output 011: DOUT is CLKOUT 100: DOUT is INT1 101: DOUT is INT2 110: DOUT is Secondary BCLK 111: DOUT is Secondary WCLK D0 R/W 0 DOUT as General Purpose Output 0: DOUT General Purpose Output is '0' 1: DOUT General Purpose Output is '1' 5.2.51 DESCRIPTION DOUT Bus Keeper Control 0: DOUT Bus Keeper Enabled 1: DOUT Bus Keeper Disabled Page 0 / Register 54: DIN/MFP1 Function Control Register - 0x00 / 0x36 BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7-D3 R 0 0000 D2-D1 R/W 01 DIN function control 00: DIN pin is disabled 01: DIN is enabled for Primary Data Input or Digital Microphone Input or General Purpose Clock input 10: DIN is used as General Purpose Input 11: Reserved. Do not use D0 R X Value of DIN input pin. To be used when for General Purpose Input 5.2.52 Reserved. Write only reserved values Page 0 / Register 55: MISO/MFP4 Function Control Register - 0x00 / 0x37 READ/ WRITE BIT DESCRIPTION RESET VALUE DESCRIPTION D7-D5 R 000 Reserved. Write only default values D4-D1 R/W 0001 MISO function control 0000: MISO buffer disabled 0001: MISO is used for data output in SPI interface, is disabled for I2C interface 0010: MISO is General Purpose Output 0011: MISO is CLKOUT output 0100: MISO is INT1 output 0101: MISO is INT2 output 0110: MISO is ADC Word Clock output 0111: MISO is clock output for Digital Microphone 1000: MISO is Secondary Data Output for Audio Interface 1001: MISO is Secondary Bit Clock for Audio Interface 1010: MISO is Secondary Word Clock for Audio Interface 1011-1111: Reserved. Do not use D0 R/W 0 5.2.53 Value to be driven on MISO pin when used as General Purpose Output Page 0 / Register 56: SCLK/MFP3 Function Control Register - 0x00 / 0x38 READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7-D3 R 0 0000 D2-D1 R/W 01 SCLK function control 00: SCLK pin is disabled 01: SCLK pin is enabled for SPI clock in SPI Interface mode or when in I2C Interface enabled for Secondary Data Input or Secondary Bit Clock Input or Secondary Word Clock or Secondary ADC Word Clock or Digital Microphone Input 10: SCLK is enabled as General Purpose Input 11: Reserved. Do not use D0 R X Value of SCLK input pin when used as General Purpose Input BIT 108 Register Map DESCRIPTION Reserved. Write only default values SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated Page 0 Registers www.ti.com 5.2.54 Page 0 / Register 57-59: Reserved Registers - 0x00 / 0x39-0x3B BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7-D0 R 0000 0000 5.2.55 BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE R 000 D4-D0 R/W 0 0001 BIT READ/ WRITE Reserved. Write only default values Selects the DAC (playback) signal processing block 0 0000: Reserved. Do not use 0 0001: DAC Signal Processing Block PRB_P1 0 0010: DAC Signal Processing Block PRB_P2 0 0011: DAC Signal Processing Block PRB_P3 0 0100: DAC Signal Processing Block PRB_P4 … 1 1000: DAC Signal Processing Block PRB_P24 1 1001: DAC Signal Processing Block PRB_P25 1 1010-1 1111: Reserved. Do not use Note; Please check the overview section for description of the Signal Processing Blocks RESET VALUE R 000 D4-D0 R/W 0 0001 DESCRIPTION Reserved. Write only default values Selects the ADC (recording) signal processing block 0 0000: Reserved. Do not use 0 0001: ADC Singal Processing Block PRB_R1 0 0010: ADC Signal Processing Block PRB_R2 0 0011: ADC Signal Processing Block PRB_R3 0 0100: ADC Signal Processing Block PRB_R4 … 1 0001: ADC Signal Processing Block PRB_R17 1 0010: ADC Signal Processing Block PRB_R18 1 0010-1 1111: Reserved. Do not use Note: Please check the overview section for description of the Signal Processing Blocks Page 0 / Register 62: Reserved Register - 0x00 / 0x3E BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7-D0 R 0000 0000 5.2.58 DESCRIPTION Page 0 / Register 61: ADC Signal Processing Block Control Register - 0x00 / 0x3D D7-D5 5.2.57 Reserved. Write only default values Page 0 / Register 60: DAC Signal Processing Block Control Register - 0x00 / 0x3C D7-D5 5.2.56 DESCRIPTION DESCRIPTION Reserved. Write only default values Page 0 / Register 63: DAC Channel Setup Register 1 - 0x00 / 0x3F BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7 R/W 0 Left DAC Channel Power Control 0: Left DAC Channel Powered Down 1: Left DAC Channel Powered Up D6 R/W 0 Right DAC Channel Power Control 0: Right DAC Channel Powered Down 1: Right DAC Channel Powered Up D5-D4 R/W 01 Left DAC Data path Control 00: Left DAC data is disabled 01: Left DAC data Left Channel Audio Interface Data 10: Left DAC data is Right Channel Audio Interface Data 11: Left DAC data is Mono Mix of Left and Right Channel Audio Interface Data D3-D2 R/W 01 Right DAC Data path Control 00: Right DAC data is disabled 01: Right DAC data Right Channel Audio Interface Data 10: Right DAC data is Left Channel Audio Interface Data 11: Right DAC data is Mono Mix of Left and Right Channel Audio Interface Data DESCRIPTION SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated Register Map 109 Page 0 Registers www.ti.com Page 0 / Register 63: DAC Channel Setup Register 1 - 0x00 / 0x3F (continued) BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D1-D0 R/W 00 5.2.59 DESCRIPTION DAC Channel Volume Control's Soft-Step control 00: Soft-Stepping is 1 step per 1 DAC Word Clock 01: Soft-Stepping is 1 step per 2 DAC Word Clocks 10: Soft-Stepping is disabled 11: Reserved. Do not use Page 0 / Register 64: DAC Channel Setup Register 2 - 0x00 / 0x40 BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7 R/W 0 D6-D4 R/W 000 DESCRIPTION Right Modulator Output Control 0: When Right DAC Channel is powered down, the data is zero. 1: When Right DAC Channel is powered down, the data is inverted version of Left DAC Modulator Output. Can be used when differential mono output is used DAC Auto Mute Control 000: Auto Mute disabled 001: DAC is auto muted if 010: DAC is auto muted if 011: DAC is auto muted if 100: DAC is auto muted if 101: DAC is auto muted if 110: DAC is auto muted if 111: DAC is auto muted if input data input data input data input data input data input data input data is is is is is is is DC for DC for DC for DC for DC for DC for DC for more than more than more than more than more than more than more than 100 consecutive inputs 200 consecutive inputs 400 consecutive inputs 800 consecutive inputs 1600 consecutive inputs 3200 consecutive inputs 6400 consecutive inputs D3 R/W 1 Left DAC Channel Mute Control 0: Left DAC Channel not muted 1: Left DAC Channel muted D2 R/W 1 Right DAC Channel Mute Control 0: Right DAC Channel not muted 1: Right DAC Channel muted D1-D0 R/W 00 DAC Master Volume Control 00: Left and Right Channel have independent volume control 01: Left Channel Volume is controlled by Right Channel Volume Control setting 10: Right Channel Volume is controlled by Left Channel Volume Control setting 11: Reserved. Do not use 5.2.60 Page 0 / Register 65: Left DAC Channel Digital Volume Control Register - 0x00 / 0x41 BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7-D0 R/W 0000 0000 110 Register Map DESCRIPTION Left DAC Channel Digital Volume Control Setting 0111 1111-0011 0001: Reserved. Do not use 0011 0000: Digital Volume Control = +24dB 0010 1111: Digital Volume Control = +23.5dB … 0000 0001: Digital Volume Control = +0.5dB 0000 0000: Digital Volume Control = 0.0dB 1111 1111: Digital Volume Control = -0.5dB ... 1000 0010: Digital Volume Control = -63dB 1000 0001: Digital Volume Control = -63.5dB 1000 0000: Reserved. Do not use SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated Page 0 Registers www.ti.com 5.2.61 Page 0 / Register 66: Right DAC Channel Digital Volume Control Register - 0x00 / 0x42 BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7-D0 R/W 0000 0000 5.2.62 DESCRIPTION Right DAC Channel Digital Volume Control Setting 0111 1111-0011 0001: Reserved. Do not use 0011 0000: Digital Volume Control = +24dB 0010 1111: Digital Volume Control = +23.5dB … 0000 0001: Digital Volume Control = +0.5dB 0000 0000: Digital Volume Control = 0.0dB 1111 1111: Digital Volume Control = -0.5dB ... 1000 0010: Digital Volume Control = -63dB 1000 0001: Digital Volume Control = -63.5dB 1000 0000: Reserved. Do not use Page 0 / Register 67: Headset Detection Configuration Register - 0x00 / 0x43 BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7 R/W 0 0: Headset Detection Disabled 1: Headset Detection Enabled D6-D5 R 00 Headset Type Flag 00: Headset not detected 01: Stereo Headset detected 10: Reserved 11: Stereo + Cellular Headset detected D4-D2 R/W 000 Headset Detection Debounce Programmability 000: Debounce Time = 16ms 001: Debounce Time = 32ms 010: Debounce Time = 64ms 011: Debounce Time = 128ms 100: Debounce Time = 256ms 101: Debounce Time = 512ms 110-111: Reserved. Do not use Note: All times are typical values D1-D0 R/W 00 Headset Button Press Debounce Programmability 00: Debounce disabled 01: Debounce Time = 8ms 10: Debounce Time = 16ms 11: Debounce Time = 32ms Note: All times are typical values 5.2.63 DESCRIPTION Page 0 / Register 68: DRC Control Register 1 - 0x00 / 0x44 READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7 R 0 Reserved. Write only default values D6 R/W 1 DRC Enable Control 0: Left Channel DRC disabled 1: Left Channel DRC enabled Note: DRC only active if a PRB_Px has been selected that supports DRC D5 R/W 1 DRC Enable Control 0: Right Channel DRC disabled 1: Right Channel DRC enabled Note: DRC only active if a PRB_Px has been selected that supports DRC D4-D2 R/W 011 BIT DESCRIPTION DRC Threshold control 000: DRC Threshold = -3dBFS 001: DRC Threshold = -6dBFS 010: DRC Threshold = -9dBFS 011: DRC Threshold = -12dBFS 100: DRC Threshold = -15dBFS 101: DRC Threshold = -18dBFS 110: DRC Threshold = -21dBFS 111: DRC Threshold = -24dBFS SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated Register Map 111 Page 0 Registers www.ti.com Page 0 / Register 68: DRC Control Register 1 - 0x00 / 0x44 (continued) BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D1-D0 R/W 11 5.2.64 DRC Hysteresis Control 00: DRC Hysteresis = 0dB 01: DRC Hysteresis = 1dB 10: DRC Hysteresis = 2dB 11: DRC Hysteresis = 3dB Page 0 / Register 69: DRC Control Register 2 - 0x00 / 0x45 READ/ WRITE BIT DESCRIPTION RESET VALUE DESCRIPTION D7 R 0 D6-D3 R/W 0111 DRC Hold Programmability 0000: DRC Hold Disabled 0001: DRC Hold Time = 32 DAC Word Clocks 0010: DRC Hold Time = 64 DAC Word Clocks 0011: DRC Hold Time = 128 DAC Word Clocks 0100: DRC Hold Time = 256 DAC Word Clocks 0101: DRC Hold Time = 512 DAC Word Clocks ... 1110: DRC Hold Time = 4*32768 DAC Word Clocks 1111: DRC Hold Time = 5*32768 DAC Word Clocks D2-D0 R/W 000 Reserved. Write only default values 5.2.65 Reserved. Write only default values. Page 0 / Register 70: DRC Control Register 3 - 0x00 / 0x46 BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7-D4 R/W 0000 DRC Attack Rate control 0000: DRC Attack Rate = 4.0dB per DAC Word Clock 0001: DRC Attack Rate = 2.0dB per DAC Word Clock 0010: DRC Attack Rae = 1.0dB per DAC Word Clock … 1110: DRC Attack Rate = 2.4414e-4dB per DAC Word Clock 1111: DRC Attack Rate = 1.2207e-4dB per DAC Word Clock D3-D0 R/W 0000 DRC Decay Rate control 0000: DRC Decay Rate = 1.5625e-2dB per DAC Word Clock 0001: DRC Decay Rate = 7.8125e-3dB per DAC Word Clock 0010: DRC Decay Rae = 3.9062e-3dB per DAC Word Clock … 1110: DRC Decay Rate = 9.5367e-7dB per DAC Word Clock 1111: DRC Decay Rate = 4.7683e-7dB per DAC Word Clock 5.2.66 DESCRIPTION Page 0 / Register 71: Beep Generator Register 1 - 0x00 / 0x47 BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7 R/W 0 0: Beep Generator Disabled 1: Beep Generator Enabled. This bit will self clear after the beep has been generated. D6 R 0 Reserved. Write only default values D5-D0 R/W 00 0000 Left Channel Beep Volume Control 00 0000: Left Channel Beep Volume 00 0001: Left Channel Beep Volume … 11 1110: Left Channel Beep Volume 11 1111: Left Channel Beep Volume 112 Register Map DESCRIPTION = 0dB = -1dB = -62dB = -63dB SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated Page 0 Registers www.ti.com 5.2.67 Page 0 / Register 72: Beep Generator Register 2 - 0x00 / 0x48 BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7-D6 R/W 00 D5-D0 R 00 0000 5.2.68 READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7-D0 R/W 0000 0000 READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7-D0 R/W 0000 0000 READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7-D0 R/W 1110 1110 READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7-D0 R/W 0001 0000 READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7-D0 R/W 1101 1000 Programmed value is Beep Sample Length(23:16) DESCRIPTION Programmed value is Beep Sample Length(15:8) DESCRIPTION Programmed value is Beep Sample Length(7:0) DESCRIPTION Programmed Value is Beep Sin(x)(15:8), where Sin(x) = sin(2*pi*Fin/Fs), where Fin is desired beep frequency and Fs is DAC sample rate DESCRIPTION Programmed Value is Beep Sin(x)(7:0), where Sin(x) = sin(2*pi*Fin/Fs), where Fin is desired beep frequency and Fs is DAC sample rate Page 0 / Register 78: Beep Generator Register 8 - 0x00 / 0x4E BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7-D0 R/W 0111 1110 5.2.74 DESCRIPTION Page 0 / Register 77: Beep Generator Register 7 - 0x00 / 0x4D BIT 5.2.73 = -62dB = -63dB Page 0 / Register 76: Beep Generator Register 6 - 0x00 / 0x4C BIT 5.2.72 = 0dB = -1dB Page 0 / Register 75: Beep Generator Register 5 - 0x00 / 0x4B BIT 5.2.71 Right Channel Beep Volume Control 00 0000: Right Channel Beep Volume 00 0001: Right Channel Beep Volume … 11 1110: Right Channel Beep Volume 11 1111: Right Channel Beep Volume Page 0 / Register 74: Beep Generator Register 4 - 0x00 / 0x4A BIT 5.2.70 Beep Generator Master Volume Control Setting 00: Left and Right Channels have independent Volume Settings 01: Left Channel Beep Volume is the same as programmed for Right Channel 10: Right Channel Beep Volume is the same as programmed for Left Channel 11: Reserved. Do not use Page 0 / Register 73: Beep Generator Register 3 - 0x00 / 0x49 BIT 5.2.69 DESCRIPTION DESCRIPTION Programmed Value is Beep Cos(x)(15:8), where Cos(x) = cos(2*pi*Fin/Fs), where Fin is desired beep frequency and Fs is DAC sample rate Page 0 / Register 79: Beep Generator Register 9 - 0x00 / 0x4F BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7-D0 R/W 1110 0011 DESCRIPTION Programmed Value is Beep Cos(x)(7:0), where Cos(x) = cos(2*π*Fin/Fs), where Fin is desired beep frequency and Fs is DAC sample rate SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated Register Map 113 Page 0 Registers 5.2.75 www.ti.com Page 0 / Register 80: Reserved Register - 0x00 / 0x50 BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7-D0 R 0000 0000 5.2.76 DESCRIPTION Reserved. Write only default values Page 0 / Register 81: ADC Channel Setup Register - 0x00 / 0x51 BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7 R/W 0 Left Channel ADC Power Control 0: Left Channel ADC is powered down 1: Left Channel ADC is powered up D6 R/W 0 Right Channel ADC Power Control 0: Right Channel ADC is powered down 1: Right Channel ADC is powered up D5-D4 R/W 00 Digital Microphone Input Configuration 00: GPIO serves as Digital Microphone Input 01: SCLK serves as Digital Microphone Input 10: DIN serves as Digital Microphone Input 11: Reserved. Do not use D3 R/W 0 Left Channel Digital Microphone Power Control 0: Left Channel ADC not configured for Digital Microphone 1: Left Channel ADC configured for Digital Microphone D2 R/W 0 Right Channel Digital Microphone Power Control 0: Right Channel ADC not configured for Digital Microphone 1: Right Channel ADC configured for Digital Microphone D1-D0 R/W 00 ADC Volume Control Soft-Stepping Control 00: ADC Volume Control changes by 1 gain step per ADC Word Clock 01: ADC Volume Control changes by 1 gain step per two ADC Word Clocks 10: ADC Volume Control Soft-Stepping disabled 11: Reserved. Do not use 5.2.77 Page 0 / Register 82: ADC Fine Gain Adjust Register - 0x00 / 0x52 BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7 R/W 1 D6-D4 R/W 000 D3 R/W 1 D2-D0 R/W 000 5.2.78 114 DESCRIPTION DESCRIPTION Left ADC Channel Mute Control 0: Left ADC Channel Un-muted 1: Left ADC Channel Muted Left ADC Channel Fine Gain Adjust 000: Left ADC Channel Fine Gain = 0dB 111: Left ADC Channel Fine Gain = -0.1dB 110: Left ADC Channel Fine Gain = -0.2dB 101: Left ADC Channel Fine Gain = -0.3dB 100: Left ADC Channel Fine Gain = -0.4dB 001-011: Reserved. Do not use Right ADC Channel Mute Control 0: Right ADC Channel Un-muted 1: Right ADC Channel Muted Right ADC Channel Fine Gain Adjust 000: Right ADC Channel Fine Gain = 0dB 111: Right ADC Channel Fine Gain = -0.1dB 110: Right ADC Channel Fine Gain = -0.2dB 101: Right ADC Channel Fine Gain = -0.3dB 100: Right ADC Channel Fine Gain = -0.4dB 001-011: Reserved. Do not use Page 0 / Register 83: Left ADC Channel Volume Control Register - 0x00 / 0x53 BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7 R 0 Register Map DESCRIPTION Reserved. Write only default values SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated Page 0 Registers www.ti.com Page 0 / Register 83: Left ADC Channel Volume Control Register - 0x00 / 0x53 (continued) BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D6-D0 R/W 000 0000 5.2.79 BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7 R 0 R/W 000 0000 DESCRIPTION Reserved. Write only default values Right ADC Channel Volume Control 000 0000-110 0111: Reserved. Do not use 110 1000: Right ADC Channel Volume = -12dB 110 1001: Right ADC Channel Volume = -11.5dB 110 1010: Right ADC Channel Volume = -11.0dB … 111 1111: Right ADC Channel Volume = -0.5dB 000 0000: Right ADC Channel Volume = 0.0dB 000 0001: Right ADC Channel Volume = 0.5dB ... 010 0110: Right ADC Channel Volume = 19.0dB 010 0111: Right ADC Channel Volume = 19.5dB 010 1000: Right ADC Channel Volume = 20.0dB 010 1001-111 1111: Reserved. Do not use Page 0 / Register 85: ADC Phase Adjust Register - 0x00 / 0x55 BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7-D0 R/W 0000 0000 5.2.81 Left ADC Channel Volume Control 000 0000-110 0111: Reserved. Do not use 110 1000: Left ADC Channel Volume = -12dB 110 1001: Left ADC Channel Volume = -11.5dB 110 1010: Left ADC Channel Volume = -11.0dB … 111 1111: Left ADC Channel Volume = -0.5dB 000 0000: Left ADC Channel Volume = 0.0dB 000 0001: Left ADC Channel Volume = 0.5dB ... 010 0110: Left ADC Channel Volume = 19.0dB 010 0111: Left ADC Channel Volume = 19.5dB 010 1000: Left ADC Channel Volume = 20.0dB 010 1001-111 1111: Reserved. Do not use Page 0 / Register 84: Right ADC Channel Volume Control Register - 0x00 / 0x54 D6-D0 5.2.80 DESCRIPTION DESCRIPTION ADC Phase Compensation Control 1000 0000-1111 1111: Left ADC Channel Data is delayed with respect to Right ADC Channel Data. For details of delayed amount please refer to the description of Phase Compensation in the Overview section. 0000 0000: Left and Right ADC Channel data are not delayed with respect to each other 0000 0001-0111 1111: Right ADC Channel Data is delayed with respect to Left ADC Channel Data. For details of delayed amount please refer to the description of Phase Compensation in the Overview section. Page 0 / Register 86: Left Channel AGC Control Register 1 - 0x00 / 0x56 BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7 R/W 0 D6-D4 R/W 000 Left Channel AGC Target Level Setting 000: Left Channel AGC Target Level = -5.5dBFS 001: Left Channel AGC Target Level = -8.0dBFS 010: Left Channel AGC Target Level = -10.0dBFS 011: Left Channel AGC Target Level = -12.0dBFS 100: Left Channel AGC Target Level = -14.0dBFS 101: Left Channel AGC Target Level = -17.0dBFS 110: Left Channel AGC Target Level = -20.0dBFS 111: Left Channel AGC Target Level = -24.0dBFS D3-D2 R 00 Reserved. Write only default values DESCRIPTION 0: Left Channel AGC Disabled 1: Left Channel AGC Enabled SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated Register Map 115 Page 0 Registers www.ti.com Page 0 / Register 86: Left Channel AGC Control Register 1 - 0x00 / 0x56 (continued) BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D1-D0 R/W 00 5.2.82 READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7-D6 R/W 00 D5-D1 R/W 0 0000 D0 R 0 D7 R 0 R/W 111 1111 READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7-D3 R/W 0 0000 116 Left Channel AGC Noise Threshold 0 0000: Left Channel AGC Noise Gate disabled 0 0001: Left Channel AGC Noise Threshold is -30dB 0 0010: Left Channel AGC Noise Threshold is -32dB 0 0011: Left Channel AGC Noise Threshold is -34dB … 1 1101: Left Channel AGC Noise Threshold is -86dB 1 1110: Left Channel AGC Noise Threshold is -88dB 1 1111: Left Channel AGC Noise Threshold is -90dB Reserved. Write only default values DESCRIPTION Reserved. Write only default values Left Channel AGC Maximum Gain Setting 000 0000: Left Channel AGC Maximum Gain = 0.0dB 000 0001: Left Channel AGC Maximum Gain = 0.5dB 000 0010: Left Channel AGC Maximum Gain = 1.0dB … 111 0011: Left Channel AGC Maximum Gain = 57.5dB 111 0100: Left Channel AGC Maximum Gain = 58.0dB 111 0101-111 1111: not recommended for usage, Left Channel AGC Maximum Gain = 58.0dB Page 0 / Register 89: Left Channel AGC Control Register 4 - 0x00 / 0x59 BIT D2-D0 Left Channel AGC Hysteresis Setting 00: Left Channel AGC Hysteresis is 1.0dB 01: Left Channel AGC Hysteresis is 2.0dB 10: Left Channel AGC Hysteresis is 4.0dB 11: Left Channel AGC Hysteresis is disabled RESET VALUE D6-D0 5.2.84 DESCRIPTION Page 0 / Register 88: Left Channel AGC Control Register 3 - 0x00 / 0x58 READ/ WRITE BIT Left Channel AGC Gain Hysteresis Control 00: Left Channel AGC Gain Hysteresis is disabled 01: Left Channel AGC Gain Hysteresis is ±0.5dB 10: Left Channel AGC Gain Hysteresis is ±1.0dB 11: Left Channel AGC Gain Hysteresis is ±1.5dB Page 0 / Register 87: Left Channel AGC Control Register 2 - 0x00 / 0x57 BIT 5.2.83 DESCRIPTION R/W Register Map 000 DESCRIPTION Left Channel AGC Attack Time Setting 0 0000: Left Channel AGC Attack Time 0 0001: Left Channel AGC Attack Time 0 0010: Left Channel AGC Attack Time … 1 1101: Left Channel AGC Attack Time 1 1110: Left Channel AGC Attack Time 1 1111: Left Channel AGC Attack Time = 1*32 ADC Word Clocks = 3*32 ADC Word Clocks = 5*32 ADC Word Clocks = 59*32 ADC Word Clocks = 61*32 ADC Word Clocks = 63*32 ADC Word Clocks Left Channel AGC Attack Time Scale Factor Setting 000: Scale Factor = 1 001: Scale Factor = 2 010: Scale Factor = 4 … 101: Scale Factor = 32 110: Scale Factor = 64 111: Scale Factor = 128 SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated Page 0 Registers www.ti.com 5.2.85 Page 0 / Register 90: Left Channel AGC Control Register 5 - 0x00 / 0x5A BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7-D3 R/W 0 0000 D2-D0 5.2.86 R/W 000 Left Channel AGC Decay Time Setting 0 0000: Left Channel AGC Decay Time 0 0001: Left Channel AGC Decay Time 0 0010: Left Channel AGC Decay Time … 1 1101: Left Channel AGC Decay Time 1 1110: Left Channel AGC Decay Time 1 1111: Left Channel AGC Decay Time = 1*512 ADC Word Clocks = 3*512 ADC Word Clocks = 5*512 ADC Word Clocks = 59*512 ADC Word Clocks = 61*512 ADC Word Clocks = 63*512 ADC Word Clocks Left Channel AGC Decay Time Scale Factor Setting 000: Scale Factor = 1 001: Scale Factor = 2 010: Scale Factor = 4 … 101: Scale Factor = 32 110: Scale Factor = 64 111: Scale Factor = 128 Page 0 / Register 91: Left Channel AGC Control Register 6 - 0x00 / 0x5B BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7-D5 R 000 D4-D0 R/W 0 0000 5.2.87 DESCRIPTION DESCRIPTION Reserved. Write only default values Left Channel AGC Noise Debounce Time Setting 0 0001: Left Channel AGC Noise Debounce Time 0 0010: Left Channel AGC Noise Debounce Time 0 0011: Left Channel AGC Noise Debounce Time … 0 1010: Left Channel AGC Noise Debounce Time 0 1011: Left Channel AGC Noise Debounce Time 0 1100: Left Channel AGC Noise Debounce Time 0 1101: Left Channel AGC Noise Debounce Time ... 1 1101: Left Channel AGC Noise Debounce Time 1 1110: Left Channel AGC Noise Debounce Time 1 1111: Left Channel AGC Noise Debounce Time =0 = 4 ADC Word Clocks = 8 ADC Word Clocks = 2048 ADC Word Clocks = 4096 ADC Word Clocks = 2*4096 ADC Word Clocks = 3*4096 ADC Word Clocks = 19*4096 ADC Word Clocks = 20*4096 ADC Word Clocks = 21*4096 ADC Word Clocks Page 0 / Register 92: Left Channel AGC Control Register 7 - 0x00 / 0x5C READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7-D4 R 0000 Reserved. Write only default values D3-D0 R/W 0000 Left Channel AGC Signal Debounce Time Setting 0001: Left Channel AGC Signal Debounce Time = 0 0010: Left Channel AGC Signal Debounce Time = 4 ADC Word Clocks 0011: Left Channel AGC Signal Debounce Time = 8 ADC Word Clocks … 1001: Left Channel AGC Signal Debounce Time = 1024 ADC Word Clocks 1010: Left Channel AGC Signal Debounce Time = 2048 ADC Word Clocks 1011: Left Channel AGC Signal Debounce Time = 2*2048 ADC Word Clocks 1100: Left Channel AGC Signal Debounce Time = 3*2048 ADC Word Clocks 1101: Left Channel AGC Signal Debounce Time = 4*2048 ADC Word Clocks 1110: Left Channel AGC Signal Debounce Time = 5*2048 ADC Word Clocks 1111: Left Channel AGC Signal Debounce Time = 6*2048 ADC Word Clocks BIT DESCRIPTION SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated Register Map 117 Page 0 Registers 5.2.88 www.ti.com Page 0 / Register 93: Left Channel AGC Control Register 8 - 0x00 / 0x5D BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7-D0 R 0000 0000 5.2.89 DESCRIPTION Left Channel AGC Gain Flag 1110 1000: Left Channel AGC 1110 1001: Left Channel AGC 1110 1010: Left Channel AGC … 0000 0000: Left Channel AGC … 0111 0010: Left Channel AGC 0111 0011: Left Channel AGC 0111 0100: Left Channel AGC Gain = -12.0dB Gain = -11.5dB Gain = -11.0dB Gain = 0.0dB Gain = 57.0dB Gain = 57.5dB Gain = 58.0dB Page 0 / Register 94: Right Channel AGC Control Register 1 - 0x00 / 0x5E BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7 R/W 0 D6-D4 R/W 000 Right Channel AGC Target Level Setting 000: Right Channel AGC Target Level = -5.5dBFS 001: Right Channel AGC Target Level = -8.0dBFS 010: Right Channel AGC Target Level = -10.0dBFS 011: Right Channel AGC Target Level = -12.0dBFS 100: Right Channel AGC Target Level = -14.0dBFS 101: Right Channel AGC Target Level = -17.0dBFS 110: Right Channel AGC Target Level = -20.0dBFS 111: Right Channel AGC Target Level = -24.0dBFS D3-D2 R 00 Reserved. Write only default values D1-D0 R/W 00 Right Channel AGC Gain Hysteresis Control 00: Right Channel AGC Gain Hysteresis is disabled 01: Right Channel AGC Gain Hysteresis is ±0.5dB 10: Right Channel AGC Gain Hysteresis is ±1.0dB 11: Right Channel AGC Gain Hysteresis is ±1.5dB 5.2.90 READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7-D6 R/W 00 D5-D1 R/W 0 0000 D0 R 0 118 0: Right Channel AGC Disabled 1: Right Channel AGC Enabled Page 0 / Register 95: Right Channel AGC Control Register 2 - 0x00 / 0x5F BIT 5.2.91 DESCRIPTION DESCRIPTION Right Channel AGC Hysteresis Setting 00: Right Channel AGC Hysteresis is 1.0dB 01: Right Channel AGC Hysteresis is 2.0dB 10: Right Channel AGC Hysteresis is 4.0dB 11: Right Channel AGC Hysteresis is disabled Right Channel AGC Noise Threshold 0 0000: Right Channel AGC Noise Gate disabled 0 0001: Right Channel AGC Noise Threshold is -30dB 0 0010: Right Channel AGC Noise Threshold is -32dB 0 0011: Right Channel AGC Noise Threshold is -34dB … 1 1101: Right Channel AGC Noise Threshold is -86dB 1 1110: Right Channel AGC Noise Threshold is -88dB 1 1111: Right Channel AGC Noise Threshold is -90dB Reserved. Write only default values Page 0 / Register 96: Right Channel AGC Control Register 3 - 0x00 / 0x60 BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7 R 0 Register Map DESCRIPTION Reserved. Write only default values SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated Page 0 Registers www.ti.com Page 0 / Register 96: Right Channel AGC Control Register 3 - 0x00 / 0x60 (continued) BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D6-D0 R/W 111 1111 5.2.92 READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7-D3 R/W 0 0000 5.2.93 R/W 000 READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7-D3 R/W 0 0000 5.2.94 DESCRIPTION Right Channel AGC Attack Time Setting 0 0000: Right Channel AGC Attack Time 0 0001: Right Channel AGC Attack Time 0 0010: Right Channel AGC Attack Time … 1 1101: Right Channel AGC Attack Time 1 1110: Right Channel AGC Attack Time 1 1111: Right Channel AGC Attack Time = 1*32 ADC Word Clocks = 3*32 ADC Word Clocks = 5*32 ADC Word Clocks = 59*32 ADC Word Clocks = 61*32 ADC Word Clocks = 63*32 ADC Word Clocks Right Channel AGC Attack Time Scale Factor Setting 000: Scale Factor = 1 001: Scale Factor = 2 010: Scale Factor = 4 … 101: Scale Factor = 32 110: Scale Factor = 64 111: Scale Factor = 128 Page 0 / Register 98: Right Channel AGC Control Register 5 - 0x00 / 0x62 BIT D2-D0 Right Channel AGC Maximum Gain Setting 000 0000: Right Channel AGC Maximum Gain = 0.0dB 000 0001: Right Channel AGC Maximum Gain = 0.5dB 000 0010: Right Channel AGC Maximum Gain = 1.0dB … 111 0011: Right Channel AGC Maximum Gain = 57.5dB 111 0100: Right Channel AGC Maximum Gain = 58.0dB 111 0101-111 1111: not recommended for usage, Right Channel AGC Maximum Gain = 58.0dB Page 0 / Register 97: Right Channel AGC Control Register 4 - 0x00 / 0x61 BIT D2-D0 DESCRIPTION R/W 000 DESCRIPTION Right Channel AGC Decay Time Setting 0 0000: Right Channel AGC Decay Time 0 0001: Right Channel AGC Decay Time 0 0010: Right Channel AGC Decay Time … 1 1101: Right Channel AGC Decay Time 1 1110: Right Channel AGC Decay Time 1 1111: Right Channel AGC Decay Time = 1*512 ADC Word Clocks = 3*512 ADC Word Clocks = 5*512 ADC Word Clocks = 59*512 ADC Word Clocks = 61*512 ADC Word Clocks = 63*512 ADC Word Clocks Right Channel AGC Decay Time Scale Factor Setting 000: Scale Factor = 1 001: Scale Factor = 2 010: Scale Factor = 4 … 101: Scale Factor = 32 110: Scale Factor = 64 111: Scale Factor = 128 Page 0 / Register 99: Right Channel AGC Control Register 6 - 0x00 / 0x63 BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7-D5 R 000 DESCRIPTION Reserved. Write only default values SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated Register Map 119 Page 0 Registers www.ti.com Page 0 / Register 99: Right Channel AGC Control Register 6 - 0x00 / 0x63 (continued) BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D4-D0 R/W 0 0000 5.2.95 DESCRIPTION Right Channel AGC Noise Debounce Time Setting 0 0001: Right Channel AGC Noise Debounce Time 0 0010: Right Channel AGC Noise Debounce Time 0 0011: Right Channel AGC Noise Debounce Time … 0 1010: Right Channel AGC Noise Debounce Time 0 1011: Right Channel AGC Noise Debounce Time 0 1100: Right Channel AGC Noise Debounce Time 0 1101: Right Channel AGC Noise Debounce Time ... 1 1101: Right Channel AGC Noise Debounce Time 1 1110: Right Channel AGC Noise Debounce Time 1 1111: Right Channel AGC Noise Debounce Time =0 = 4 ADC Word Clocks = 8 ADC Word Clocks = 2048 ADC Word Clocks = 4096 ADC Word Clocks = 2*4096 ADC Word Clocks = 3*4096 ADC Word Clocks = 19*4096 ADC Word Clocks = 20*4096 ADC Word Clocks = 21*4096 ADC Word Clocks Page 0 / Register 100: Right Channel AGC Control Register 7 - 0x00 / 0x64 READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7-D4 R 0000 Reserved. Write only default values D3-D0 R/W 0000 Right Channel AGC Signal Debounce Time Setting 0001: Right Channel AGC Signal Debounce Time = 0 0010: Right Channel AGC Signal Debounce Time = 4 ADC Word Clocks 0011: Right Channel AGC Signal Debounce Time = 8 ADC Word Clocks … 1001: Right Channel AGC Signal Debounce Time = 1024 ADC Word Clocks 1010: Right Channel AGC Signal Debounce Time = 2048 ADC Word Clocks 1011: Right Channel AGC Signal Debounce Time = 2*2048 ADC Word Clocks 1100: Right Channel AGC Signal Debounce Time = 3*2048 ADC Word Clocks 1101: Right Channel AGC Signal Debounce Time = 4*2048 ADC Word Clocks 1110: Right Channel AGC Signal Debounce Time = 5*2048 ADC Word Clocks 1111: Right Channel AGC Signal Debounce Time = 6*2048 ADC Word Clocks BIT 5.2.96 Page 0 / Register 101: Right Channel AGC Control Register 8 - 0x00 / 0x65 BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7-D0 R 0000 0000 5.2.97 120 DESCRIPTION DESCRIPTION Right Channel AGC Gain Flag 1110 1000: Right Channel AGC 1110 1001: Right Channel AGC 1110 1010: Right Channel AGC … 0000 0000: Right Channel AGC … 0111 0010: Right Channel AGC 0111 0011: Right Channel AGC 0111 0100: Right Channel AGC Gain = -12.0dB Gain = -11.5dB Gain = -11.0dB Gain = 0.0dB Gain = 57.0dB Gain = 57.5dB Gain = 58.0dB Page 0 / Register 102: DC Measurement Register 1 - 0x00 / 0x66 BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7 R/W 0 0: DC Measurement Mode disabled for Left ADC Channel 1: DC Measurement Mode enabled for Left ADC Channel D6 R/W 0 0: DC Measurement Mode disabled for Right ADC Channel 1: DC Measurement Mode enabled for Right ADC Channel D5 R/W 0 0: DC Measurement is done using 1st order moving average filter with averaging of 2^D 1: DC Measurement is done with 1sr order Low-pass IIR filter with coefficients as a function of D Register Map DESCRIPTION SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated Page 0 Registers www.ti.com Page 0 / Register 102: DC Measurement Register 1 - 0x00 / 0x66 (continued) BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D4-D0 R/W 0 0000 5.2.98 DESCRIPTION DC Measurement D setting 0 0000: Reserved. Do not use 0 0001: DC Measurement D parameter 0 0010: DC Measurement D parameter .. 1 0011: DC Measurement D parameter 1 0100: DC Measurement D parameter 1 0101-1 1111: Reserved. Do not use =1 =2 = 19 = 20 Page 0 / Register 103: DC Measurement Register 2 - 0x00 / 0x67 READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7 R 0 Reserved. Write only default values D6 R/W 0 0: Left and Right Channel DC measurement result update enabled 1: Left and Right Channel DC measurement result update disabled i.e. new results will be updated while old results are being read D5 R/W 0 0: For IIR based DC measurement, measurement value is the instantaneous output of IIR filter 1: For IIR based DC measurement, the measurement value is updated before periodic clearing of IIR filter D4-D0 R/W 0 0000 BIT 5.2.99 DESCRIPTION IIR based DC Measurement, averaging time setting 0 0000: Infinite average is used 0 0001: Averaging time is 2^1 ADC Modulator clocks 0 0010: Averaging time is 2^2 ADC Modulator clocks … 1 0011: Averaging time is 2^19 ADC Modulator clocks 1 0100: Averaging time is 2^20 ADC Modulator clocks 1 0101-1 1111: Reserved. Do not use Page 0 / Register 104: Left Channel DC Measurement Output Register 1 - 0x00 / 0x68 BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7-D0 R 0000 0000 DESCRIPTION Left Channel DC Measurement Output (23:16) 5.2.100 Page 0 / Register 105: Left Channel DC Measurement Output Register 2 - 0x00 / 0x69 BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7-D0 R 0000 0000 DESCRIPTION Left Channel DC Measurement Output (15:8) 5.2.101 Page 0 / Register 106: Left Channel DC Measurement Output Register 3 - 0x00 / 0x6A BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7-D0 R 0000 0000 DESCRIPTION Left Channel DC Measurement Output (7:0) 5.2.102 Page 0 / Register 107: Right Channel DC Measurement Output Register 1 - 0x00 / 0x6B BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7-D0 R 0000 0000 DESCRIPTION Right Channel DC Measurement Output (23:16) 5.2.103 Page 0 / Register 108: Right Channel DC Measurement Output Register 2 - 0x00 / 0x6C BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7-D0 R 0000 0000 DESCRIPTION Right Channel DC Measurement Output (15:8) SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated Register Map 121 Page 1 Registers www.ti.com 5.2.104 Page 0 / Register 109: Right Channel DC Measurement Output Register 3 - 0x00 / 0x6D BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7-D0 R 0000 0000 DESCRIPTION Right Channel DC Measurement Output (7:0) 5.2.105 Page 0 / Register 110-127: Reserved Register - 0x00 / 0x6E-0x7F BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7-D0 R 0000 0000 5.3 DESCRIPTION Reserved. Write only default values Page 1 Registers 5.3.1 Page 1 / Register 0: Page Select Register - 0x01 / 0x00 BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7-D0 R/W 0000 0000 5.3.2 DESCRIPTION Page Select Register 0-255: Selects the Register Page for next read or write command. Refer Table "Summary of Memory Map" for details. Page 1 / Register 1: Power Configuration Register 1 - 0x01 / 0x01 READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7-D4 R 0000 D3 R/W 0 0: AVDD will be weakly connected to DVDD. Use while AVDD is not externally powered 1: Disabled weak connection of AVDD with DVDD D2 R/W 0 Reserved. Write only default values D1-D0 R/W 00 Charge Pump Conrol and Configuration 00: Power Down Charge Pump 01: Reserved. Do not use. 10: Power Up Charge Pump with Internal Oscillator Clock (nom. 8MHz) 11: Reserved. Do not use. BIT 5.3.3 DESCRIPTION Reserved. Write only default values Page 1 / Register 2: Power Configuration Register 2 - 0x01 / 0x02 BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7-D6 R/W 00 Reserved. Write only default values D5-D4 R/W 00 Reserved. Write only default values D3 R/W 1 Analog Block Power Control 0: Analog Blocks Enabled 1: Analog Blocks Disabled D2 R 0 Headphone Driver Powerup Flag This flag is conditional to Page 1 / Register 10 D2 For Page 1 / Register 10 D2 = 1 it shows the status of HPL else the status of HPR 0: The Headphone Driver is powered down or not yet completely powered up 1: The Headphone Driver is completely powered up. D1 R 0 Reserved. D0 R/W 0 Reserved. Write only default values 5.3.4 DESCRIPTION Page 1 / Register 3: Playback Configuration Register 1 - 0x01 / 0x03 BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7-D6 R/W 00 Reserved. Write only default values D5 R/W 0 Left DAC performance mode selection 0: Left DAC is enabled in high performance mode 1: Left DAC is enabled in normal mode 122 Register Map DESCRIPTION SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated Page 1 Registers www.ti.com Page 1 / Register 3: Playback Configuration Register 1 - 0x01 / 0x03 (continued) BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D4-D2 R/W 000 Left DAC PTM Control 000: Left DAC in mode PTM_P3, PTM_P4 001: Left DAC in mode PTM_P2 010: Left DAC in mode PTM_P1 011-111: Reserved. Do not use D1-D0 R 00 Reserved. Write only default values 5.3.5 DESCRIPTION Page 1 / Register 4: Playback Configuration Register 2 - 0x01 / 0x04 BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7-D6 R/W 00 Reserved. Write only default values D5 R/W 0 Right DAC performance mode selection 0: Right DAC is enabled in high performance mode 1: Right DAC is enabled in normal mode D4-D2 R/W 000 Right DAC PTM Control 000: Right DAC in mode PTM_P3, PTM_P4 001: Right DAC in mode PTM_P2 010: Right DAC in mode PTM_P1 011-111: Reserved. Do not use D1-D0 R 00 Reserved. Write only default values 5.3.6 Page 1 / Register 5-8: Reserved Register - 0x01 / 0x05-0x08 BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7-D0 R 0000 0000 5.3.7 DESCRIPTION DESCRIPTION Reserved. Write only default values Page 1 / Register 9: Output Driver Power Control Register - 0x01 / 0x09 BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7-D6 R 00 Reserved. Write only default value D5 R/W 0 0: HPL is powered down 1: HPL is powered up D4 R/W 0 0: HPR is powered down 1: HPR is powered up D3 R/W 0 0: LOL is powered down 1: LOL is powered up D2 R/W 0 0: LOR is powered down 1: LOR is powered up D1 R/W 0 0: Left Mixer Amplifier(MAL) is powered down 1: Left Mixer Amplifier(MAL) is powered up D0 R/W 0 0: Right Mixer Amplifier(MAR) is powered down 1: Right Mixer Amplifier(MAR) is powered up 5.3.8 DESCRIPTION Page 1 / Register 10: Common Mode Control Register - 0x01 / 0x0A READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7 R 0 Reserved. Write only default value. D6 R/W 0 0: Full Chip Common Mode is 0.9V 1: Full Chip Common Mode is 0.75V D5-D4 R/W 00 00: 01: 10: 11: BIT DESCRIPTION Output Output Output Output Common Common Common Common Mode Mode Mode Mode for for for for HPL & HPL & HPL & HPL & HPR HPR HPR HPR is is is is same as full-chip common mode 1.25V 1.5V 1.65V if D6=0, 1.5V if D6=1 SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated Register Map 123 Page 1 Registers www.ti.com Page 1 / Register 10: Common Mode Control Register - 0x01 / 0x0A (continued) BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D3 R/W 0 0: Output Common Mode for LOL & LOR is same as full-chip common mode 1: Output Common Mode for LOL & LOR is 1.65V and output is powered by DRVDD_HP. DRVDD_HP supply should be >3.3V & VNEG connected to AVSS. D2 R/W 0 Ground Centered Headphone Flag Channel Selection Page 1 / Register 2 D2 will show status according to the following selection: 0: Flag shows HPR status 1: Flag shows HPL status D1-D0 R/W 00 GND SENSE Configuration 00: Enable GND_SENSE for ground centered mode of operation. 01: Do not use 10: Disable GND_SENSE for ground centered mode of operation 11: Do not use 5.3.9 DESCRIPTION Page 1 / Register 11: Over Current Protection Configuration Register - 0x01 / 0x0B READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7-D5 R 000 D4 R/W 1 D3-D1 R/W 000 D0 R/W 0 BIT 5.3.10 DESCRIPTION Reserved. Write only default values Reserved, Do not write '0' 000: 001: 010: 011: 100: 101: 110: 111: No debounce is used for Over Current detection Over Current detection is debounced by 8ms Over Current detection is debounce by 16ms Over Current detection is debounced by 32ms Over Current detection is debounced by 64ms Over Current detection is debounced by 128ms Over Current detection is debounced by 256ms Over Current detection is debounced by 512ms 0: Output current will be limited if over current condition is detected 1: Output driver will be powered down if over current condition is detected Page 1 / Register 12: HPL Routing Selection Register - 0x01 / 0x0C READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7-D4 R 0000 D3 R/W 0 0: Left Channel DAC reconstruction filter's positive terminal is not routed to HPL 1: Left Channel DAC reconstruction filter's positive terminal is routed to HPL D2 R/W 0 0: IN1L is not routed to HPL 1: IN1L is routed to HPL D1 R/W 0 0: MAL output is not routed to HPL 1: MAL output is routed to HPL D0 R/W 0 0: MAR output is not routed to HPL 1: MAR output is routed to HPL BIT 5.3.11 DESCRIPTION Reserved. Write only default values Page 1 / Register 13: HPR Routing Selection Register - 0x01 / 0x0D READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7-D5 R 000 D4 R/W 0 0: Left Channel DAC reconstruction filter's negative terminal is not routed to HPR 1: Left Channel DAC reconstruction filter's negative terminal is routed to HPR D3 R/W 0 0: Right Channel DAC reconstruction filter's positive terminal is not routed to HPR 1: Right Channel DAC reconstruction filter's positive terminal is routed to HPR D2 R/W 0 0: IN1R is not routed to HPR 1: IN1R is routed to HPR D1 R/W 0 0: MAR output is not routed to HPR 1: MAR output is routed to HPR D0 R/W 0 Reserved. Write only default values BIT 124 Register Map DESCRIPTION Reserved. Write only default values SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated Page 1 Registers www.ti.com 5.3.12 Page 1 / Register 14: LOL Routing Selection Register - 0x01 / 0x0E BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7-D5 R 000 D4 R/W 0 0: Right Channel DAC reconstruction filter's negative terminal is not routed to LOL 1: Right Channel DAC reconstruction filter's negative terminal is routed to LOL D3 R/W 0 0: Left Channel DAC reconstruction filter output is not routed to LOL 1: Left Channel DAC reconstruction filter output is routed to LOL D2 R 0 Reserved. Write only default value. D1 R/W 0 0: MAL output is not routed to LOL 1: MAL output is routed to LOL D0 R/W 0 0: LOR output is not routed to LOL 1: LOR output is routed to LOL(use when LOL&LOR output is powered by AVDD) 5.3.13 DESCRIPTION Reserved. Write only default values Page 1 / Register 15: LOR Routing Selection Register - 0x01 / 0x0F READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7-D4 R 0000 D3 R/W 0 0: Right Channel DAC reconstruction filter output is not routed to LOR 1: Right Channel DAC reconstruction filter output is routed to LOR D2 R 0 Reserved. Write only default value. D1 R/W 0 0: MAR output is not routed to LOR 1: MAR output is routed to LOR D0 R 0 Reserved. Write only default value. BIT 5.3.14 DESCRIPTION Reserved. Write only default values Page 1 / Register 16: HPL Driver Gain Setting Register - 0x01 / 0x10 READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7 R 0 Reserved. Write only default value. D6 R/W 1 0: HPL driver is not muted 1: HPL driver is muted D5-D0 R/W 00 0000 BIT 5.3.15 DESCRIPTION 10 0000-11 1001: Reserved. Do not use 11 1010: HPL driver gain is -6dB (Note: It is not possible to mute HPR while programmed to -6dB) 11 1011: HPL driver gain is -5dB 11 1100: HPL driver gain is -4dB … 00 0000: HPL driver gain is 0dB ... 00 1110: HPL driver gain is 14dB 00 1111-01 1111: Reserved. Do not use Page 1 / Register 17: HPR Driver Gain Setting Register - 0x01 / 0x11 READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7 R 0 Reserved. Write only default value. D6 R/W 1 0: HPR driver is not muted 1: HPR driver is muted D5-D0 R/W 00 0000 BIT DESCRIPTION 10 0000-11 1001: Reserved. Do not use 11 1010: HPR driver gain is -6dB (Note: It is not possible to mute HPR while programmed to -6dB) 11 1011: HPR driver gain is -5dB 11 1100: HPR driver gain is -4dB … 00 0000: HPR driver gain is 0dB ... 00 1110: HPR driver gain is 14dB 00 1111-01 1111: Reserved. Do not use SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated Register Map 125 Page 1 Registers 5.3.16 www.ti.com Page 1 / Register 18: LOL Driver Gain Setting Register - 0x01 / 0x12 BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7 R 0 Reserved. Write only default value. D6 R/W 1 0: LOL driver is not muted 1: LOL driver is muted D5-D0 R/W 00 0000 5.3.17 DESCRIPTION 10 11 11 11 … 00 ... 01 01 01 01 0000-11 1001: Reserved. Do not use 1010: LOL driver gain is -6dB 1011: LOL driver gain is -5dB 1100: LOL driver gain is -4dB 0000: LOL driver gain is 0dB 1011: LOL driver gain is 27dB 1100: LOL driver gain is 28dB 1101: LOL driver gain is 29dB 1110-01 1111: Reserved. Do not use Page 1 / Register 19: LOR Driver Gain Setting Register - 0x01 / 0x13 READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7 R 0 Reserved. Write only default value. D6 R/W 1 0: LOR driver is not muted 1: LOR driver is muted D5-D0 R/W 00 0000 BIT 5.3.18 10 11 11 11 … 00 ... 01 01 01 01 0000-11 1001: Reserved. Do not use 1010: LOR driver gain is -6dB 1011: LOR driver gain is -5dB 1100: LOR driver gain is -4dB 0000: LOR driver gain is 0dB 1011: LOR driver gain is 27dB 1100: LOR driver gain is 28dB 1101: LOR driver gain is 29dB 1110-01 1111: Reserved. Do not use Page 1 / Register 20: Headphone Driver Startup Control Register - 0x01 / 0x14 BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7-D6 R/W 00 D5-D2 R/W 0000 D1-D0 R/W 00 126 DESCRIPTION Register Map DESCRIPTION 00: 01: 10: 11: Soft routing Soft routing Soft routing Soft routing step step step step time is time is time is time is 0ms 50ms 100ms 200ms 0000: Slow power up of headphone amp's is disabled 0001: Headphone amps power up slowly in 0.5 time constants 0010: Headphone amps power up slowly in 0.625 time constants 0011; Headphone amps power up slowly in 0.725 time constants 0100: Headphone amps power up slowly in 0.875 time constants 0101: Headphone amps power up slowly in 1.0 time constants 0110: Headphone amps power up slowly in 2.0 time constants 0111: Headphone amps power up slowly in 3.0 time constants 1000: Headphone amps power up slowly in 4.0 time constants 1001: Headphone amps power up slowly in 5.0 time constants 1010: Headphone amps power up slowly in 6.0 time constants 1011: Headphone amps power up slowly in 7.0 time constants 1100: Headphone amps power up slowly in 8.0 time constants 1101: Headphone amps power up slowly in 16.0 time constants ( do not use for Rchg=25K) 1110: Headphone amps power up slowly in 24.0 time constants (do not use for Rchg=25K) 1111: Headphone amps power up slowly in 32.0 time constants (do not use for Rchg=25K) Note: Time constants assume 47uF decoupling cap 00: 01: 10: 11: Headphone amps power up time is determined with 25K resistance Headphone amps power up time is determined with 6K resistance Headphone amps power up time is determined with 2K resistance Reserved. Do not use SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated Page 1 Registers www.ti.com 5.3.19 Page 1 / Register 21: Reserved Register - 0x01 / 0x15 BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7-D0 R 0000 0000 5.3.20 DESCRIPTION Reserved. Write only default values Page 1 / Register 22: IN1L to HPL Volume Control Register - 0x01 / 0x16 BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7 R 0 DESCRIPTION Reserved. Write only default value. SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated Register Map 127 Page 1 Registers www.ti.com Page 1 / Register 22: IN1L to HPL Volume Control Register - 0x01 / 0x16 (continued) BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D6-D0 R/W 000 0000 128 Register Map DESCRIPTION IN1L to HPL Volume Control 000 0000: Volume Control = 0.0dB 000 0001: Volume Control = -0.5dB 000 0010: Volume Control = -1.0dB 000 0011: Volume Control = -1.5dB 000 0100: Volume Control = -2.0dB 000 0101: Volume Control = -2.5dB 000 0110: Volume Control = -3.0dB 000 0111: Volume Control = -3.5dB 000 1000: Volume Control = -4.0dB 000 1001: Volume Control = -4.5dB 000 1010: Volume Control = -5.0dB 000 1011: Volume Control = -5.5dB 000 1100: Volume Control = -6.0dB 000 1101: Volume Control = -7.0dB 000 1110: Volume Control = -8.0dB 000 1111: Volume Control = -8.5dB 001 0000: Volume Control = -9.0dB 001 0001: Volume Control = -9.5dB 001 0010: Volume Control = -10.0dB 001 0011: Volume Control = -10.5dB 001 0100: Volume Control = -11.0dB 001 0101: Volume Control = -11.5dB 001 0110: Volume Control = -12.0dB 001 0111: Volume Control = -12.5dB 001 1000: Volume Control = -13.0dB 001 1001: Volume Control = -13.5dB 001 1010: Volume Control = -14.0dB 001 1011: Volume Control = -14.5dB 001 1100: Volume Control = -15.0dB 001 1101: Volume Control = -15.5dB 001 1110: Volume Control = -16.0dB 001 1111: Volume Control = -16.5dB 010 0000: Volume Control = -17.1dB 010 0001: Volume Control = -17.5dB 010 0010: Volume Control = -18.1dB 010 0011: Volume Control = -18.6dB 010 0100: Volume Control = -19.1dB 010 0101: Volume Control = -19.6dB 010 0110: Volume Control = -20.1dB 010 0111: Volume Control = -20.6dB 010 1000: Volume Control = -21.1dB 010 1001: Volume Control = -21.6dB 010 1010: Volume Control = -22.1dB 010 1011: Volume Control = -22.6dB 010 1100: Volume Control = -23.1dB 010 1101: Volume Control = -23.6dB 010 1110: Volume Control = -24.1dB 010 1111: Volume Control = -24.6dB 011 0000: Volume Control = -25.1dB 011 0001: Volume Control = -25.6dB 011 0010: Volume Control = -26.1dB 011 0011: Volume Control = -26.6dB 011 0100: Volume Control = -27.1dB 011 0101: Volume Control = -27.6dB 011 0110: Volume Control = -28.1dB 011 0111: Volume Control = -28.6dB 011 1000: Volume Control = -29.1dB 011 1001: Volume Control = -29.6dB 011 1010: Volume Control = -30.1dB 011 1011: Volume Control = -30.6dB 011 1100: Volume Control = -31.1dB 011 1100: Volume Control = -31.6dB 011 1101: Volume Control = -32.1dB 011 1110: Volume Control = -32.6dB 011 1111: Volume Control = -33.1dB 100 0000: Volume Control = -33.6dB 100 0001: Volume Control = -34.1dB SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated Page 1 Registers www.ti.com Page 1 / Register 22: IN1L to HPL Volume Control Register - 0x01 / 0x16 (continued) BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE DESCRIPTION 100 0010: Volume Control = -34.6dB 100 0011: Volume Control = -35.2dB 100 0100: Volume Control = -35.7dB 100 0101: Volume Control = -36.2dB 100 0110: Volume Control = -36.7dB 100 0111: Volume Control = -37.2dB 100 1000: Volume Control = -37.7dB 100 1001: Volume Control = -38.2dB 100 1010: Volume Control = -38.7dB 100 1011: Volume Control = -39.2dB 100 1100: Volume Control = -39.7dB 100 1101: Volume Control = -40.2dB 100 1110: Volume Control = -40.7dB 100 1111: Volume Control = -41.2dB 101 0000: Volume Control = -41.7dB 101 0001: Volume Control = -42.1dB 101 0010: Volume Control = -42.7dB 101 0011: Volume Control = -43.2dB 101 0100: Volume Control = -43.8dB 101 0101: Volume Control = -44.3dB 101 0110: Volume Control = -44.8dB 101 0111: Volume Control = -45.2dB 101 1000: Volume Control = -45.8dB 101 1001: Volume Control = -46.2dB 101 1010: Volume Control = -46.7dB 101 1011: Volume Control = -47.4dB 101 1100: Volume Control = -47.9dB 101 1101: Volume Control = -48.2dB 101 1110: Volume Control = -48.7dB 101 1111: Volume Control = -49.3dB 110 0000: Volume Control = -50.0dB 110 0001: Volume Control = -50.3dB 110 0010: Volume Control = -51.0dB 110 0011: Volume Control = -51.42dB 110 0100: Volume Control = -51.82dB 110 0101: Volume Control = -52.3dB 110 0110: Volume Control = -52.7dB 110 0111: Volume Control = -53.7dB 110 1000: Volume Control = -54.2dB 110 1001: Volume Control = -55.4dB 110 1010: Volume Control = -56.7dB 110 1011: Volume Control = -58.3dB 110 1100: Volume Control = -60.2dB 110 1101: Volume Control = -62.7dB 110 1110: Volume Control = -64.3dB 110 1111: Volume Control = -66.2dB 111 0000: Volume Control = -68.7dB 111 0001: Volume Control = -72.3dB 111 0010: Volume Control = MUTE 111 0011-111 1111: Reserved. Do not use 5.3.21 Page 1 / Register 23: IN1R to HPR Volume Control Register - 0x01 / 0x17 BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7 R 0 DESCRIPTION Reserved. Write only default value SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated Register Map 129 Page 1 Registers www.ti.com Page 1 / Register 23: IN1R to HPR Volume Control Register - 0x01 / 0x17 (continued) BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D6-D0 R/W 000 0000 130 Register Map DESCRIPTION IN1R to HPR Volume Control 000 0000: Volume Control = 0.0dB 000 0001: Volume Control = -0.5dB 000 0010: Volume Control = -1.0dB 000 0011: Volume Control = -1.5dB 000 0100: Volume Control = -2.0dB 000 0101: Volume Control = -2.5dB 000 0110: Volume Control = -3.0dB 000 0111: Volume Control = -3.5dB 000 1000: Volume Control = -4.0dB 000 1001: Volume Control = -4.5dB 000 1010: Volume Control = -5.0dB 000 1011: Volume Control = -5.5dB 000 1100: Volume Control = -6.0dB 000 1101: Volume Control = -7.0dB 000 1110: Volume Control = -8.0dB 000 1111: Volume Control = -8.5dB 001 0000: Volume Control = -9.0dB 001 0001: Volume Control = -9.5dB 001 0010: Volume Control = -10.0dB 001 0011: Volume Control = -10.5dB 001 0100: Volume Control = -11.0dB 001 0101: Volume Control = -11.5dB 001 0110: Volume Control = -12.0dB 001 0111: Volume Control = -12.5dB 001 1000: Volume Control = -13.0dB 001 1001: Volume Control = -13.5dB 001 1010: Volume Control = -14.0dB 001 1011: Volume Control = -14.5dB 001 1100: Volume Control = -15.0dB 001 1101: Volume Control = -15.5dB 001 1110: Volume Control = -16.0dB 001 1111: Volume Control = -16.5dB 010 0000: Volume Control = -17.1dB 010 0001: Volume Control = -17.5dB 010 0010: Volume Control = -18.1dB 010 0011: Volume Control = -18.6dB 010 0100: Volume Control = -19.1dB 010 0101: Volume Control = -19.6dB 010 0110: Volume Control = -20.1dB 010 0111: Volume Control = -20.6dB 010 1000: Volume Control = -21.1dB 010 1001: Volume Control = -21.6dB 010 1010: Volume Control = -22.1dB 010 1011: Volume Control = -22.6dB 010 1100: Volume Control = -23.1dB 010 1101: Volume Control = -23.6dB 010 1110: Volume Control = -24.1dB 010 1111: Volume Control = -24.6dB 011 0000: Volume Control = -25.1dB 011 0001: Volume Control = -25.6dB 011 0010: Volume Control = -26.1dB 011 0011: Volume Control = -26.6dB 011 0100: Volume Control = -27.1dB 011 0101: Volume Control = -27.6dB 011 0110: Volume Control = -28.1dB 011 0111: Volume Control = -28.6dB 011 1000: Volume Control = -29.1dB 011 1001: Volume Control = -29.6dB 011 1010: Volume Control = -30.1dB 011 1011: Volume Control = -30.6dB 011 1100: Volume Control = -31.1dB 011 1100: Volume Control = -31.6dB 011 1101: Volume Control = -32.1dB 011 1110: Volume Control = -32.6dB 011 1111: Volume Control = -33.1dB 100 0000: Volume Control = -33.6dB 100 0001: Volume Control = -34.1dB SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated Page 1 Registers www.ti.com Page 1 / Register 23: IN1R to HPR Volume Control Register - 0x01 / 0x17 (continued) BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE DESCRIPTION 100 0010: Volume Control = -34.6dB 100 0011: Volume Control = -35.2dB 100 0100: Volume Control = -35.7dB 100 0101: Volume Control = -36.2dB 100 0110: Volume Control = -36.7dB 100 0111: Volume Control = -37.2dB 100 1000: Volume Control = -37.7dB 100 1001: Volume Control = -38.2dB 100 1010: Volume Control = -38.7dB 100 1011: Volume Control = -39.2dB 100 1100: Volume Control = -39.7dB 100 1101: Volume Control = -40.2dB 100 1110: Volume Control = -40.7dB 100 1111: Volume Control = -41.2dB 101 0000: Volume Control = -41.7dB 101 0001: Volume Control = -42.1dB 101 0010: Volume Control = -42.7dB 101 0011: Volume Control = -43.2dB 101 0100: Volume Control = -43.8dB 101 0101: Volume Control = -44.3dB 101 0110: Volume Control = -44.8dB 101 0111: Volume Control = -45.2dB 101 1000: Volume Control = -45.8dB 101 1001: Volume Control = -46.2dB 101 1010: Volume Control = -46.7dB 101 1011: Volume Control = -47.4dB 101 1100: Volume Control = -47.9dB 101 1101: Volume Control = -48.2dB 101 1110: Volume Control = -48.7dB 101 1111: Volume Control = -49.3dB 110 0000: Volume Control = -50.0dB 110 0001: Volume Control = -50.3dB 110 0010: Volume Control = -51.0dB 110 0011: Volume Control = -51.42dB 110 0100: Volume Control = -51.82dB 110 0101: Volume Control = -52.3dB 110 0110: Volume Control = -52.7dB 110 0111: Volume Control = -53.7dB 110 1000: Volume Control = -54.2dB 110 1001: Volume Control = -55.4dB 110 1010: Volume Control = -56.7dB 110 1011: Volume Control = -58.3dB 110 1100: Volume Control = -60.2dB 110 1101: Volume Control = -62.7dB 110 1110: Volume Control = -64.3dB 110 1111: Volume Control = -66.2dB 111 0000: Volume Control = -68.7dB 111 0001: Volume Control = -72.3dB 111 0010: Volume Control = MUTE 111 0011-111 1111: Reserved. Do not use 5.3.22 Page 1 / Register 24: Mixer Amplifier Left Volume Control Register - 0x01 / 0x18 BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7-D6 R 00 DESCRIPTION Reserved. Write only default values SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated Register Map 131 Page 1 Registers www.ti.com Page 1 / Register 24: Mixer Amplifier Left Volume Control Register - 0x01 / 0x18 (continued) BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D5-D0 R/W 00 0000 5.3.23 Mixer Amplifier Left Volume Control 00 0000: Volume Control = 0.0dB 00 0001: Volume Control = -0.4dB 00 0010: Volume Control = -0.9dB 00 0011: Volume Control = -1.3dB 00 0100: Volume Control = -1.8dB 00 0101: Volume Control = -2.3dB 00 0110: Volume Control = -2.9dB 00 0111: Volume Control = -3.3dB 00 1000: Volume Control = -3.9dB 00 1001: Volume Control = -4.3dB 00 1010: Volume Control = -4.8dB 00 1011: Volume Control = -5.2dB 00 1100: Volume Control = -5.8dB 00 1101: Volume Control = -6.3dB 00 1110: Volume Control = -6.6dB 00 1111: Volume Control = -7.2dB 01 0000: Volume Control = -7.8dB 01 0001: Volume Control = -8.2dB 01 0010: Volume Control = -8.5dB 01 0011: Volume Control = -9.3dB 01 0100: Volume Control = -9.7dB 01 0101: Volume Control = -10.1dB 01 0110: Volume Control = -10.6dB 01 0111: Volume Control = -11.0dB 01 1000: Volume Control = -11.5dB 01 1001: Volume Control = -12.0dB 01 1010: Volume Control = -12.6dB 01 1011: Volume Control = -13.2dB 01 1100: Volume Control = -13.8dB 01 1101: Volume Control = -14.5dB 01 1110: Volume Control = -15.3dB 01 1111: Volume Control = -16.1dB 10 0000: Volume Control = -17.0dB 10 0001: Volume Control = -18.1dB 10 0010: Volume Control = -19.2dB 10 0011: Volume Control = -20.6dB 10 0100: Volume Control = -22.1dB 10 0101: Volume Control = -24.1dB 10 0110: Volume Control = -26.6dB 10 0111: Volume Control = -30.1dB 10 1000: Volume Control = MUTE 10 1001-11 1111: Reserved. Do no use Page 1 / Register 25: Mixer Amplifier Right Volume Control Register - 0x01 / 0x19 BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7-D6 R 00 132 DESCRIPTION Register Map DESCRIPTION Reserved. Write only default values SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated Page 1 Registers www.ti.com Page 1 / Register 25: Mixer Amplifier Right Volume Control Register - 0x01 / 0x19 (continued) BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D5-D0 R/W 00 0000 5.3.24 Mixer Amplifier Right Volume Control 00 0000: Volume Control = 0.0dB 00 0001: Volume Control = -0.4dB 00 0010: Volume Control = -0.9dB 00 0011: Volume Control = -1.3dB 00 0100: Volume Control = -1.8dB 00 0101: Volume Control = -2.3dB 00 0110: Volume Control = -2.9dB 00 0111: Volume Control = -3.3dB 00 1000: Volume Control = -3.9dB 00 1001: Volume Control = -4.3dB 00 1010: Volume Control = -4.8dB 00 1011: Volume Control = -5.2dB 00 1100: Volume Control = -5.8dB 00 1101: Volume Control = -6.3dB 00 1110: Volume Control = -6.6dB 00 1111: Volume Control = -7.2dB 01 0000: Volume Control = -7.8dB 01 0001: Volume Control = -8.2dB 01 0010: Volume Control = -8.5dB 01 0011: Volume Control = -9.3dB 01 0100: Volume Control = -9.7dB 01 0101: Volume Control = -10.1dB 01 0110: Volume Control = -10.6dB 01 0111: Volume Control = -11.0dB 01 1000: Volume Control = -11.5dB 01 1001: Volume Control = -12.0dB 01 1010: Volume Control = -12.6dB 01 1011: Volume Control = -13.2dB 01 1100: Volume Control = -13.8dB 01 1101: Volume Control = -14.5dB 01 1110: Volume Control = -15.3dB 01 1111: Volume Control = -16.1dB 10 0000: Volume Control = -17.0dB 10 0001: Volume Control = -18.1dB 10 0010: Volume Control = -19.2dB 10 0011: Volume Control = -20.6dB 10 0100: Volume Control = -22.1dB 10 0101: Volume Control = -24.1dB 10 0110: Volume Control = -26.6dB 10 0111: Volume Control = -30.1dB 10 1000: Volume Control = MUTE 10 1001-11 1111: Reserved. Do no use Page 1 / Register 26-50: Reserved Register - 0x01 / 0x1A-0x32 BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7-D0 R 0000 0000 5.3.25 DESCRIPTION DESCRIPTION Reserved. Write only default values Page 1 / Register 51: MICBIAS Configuration Register - 0x01 / 0x33 READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7 R 0 Reserved. Write only default value. D6 R/W 0 0: MICBIAS powered down 1: MICBIAS powered up D5-D4 R/W 00 MICBIAS Output Voltage Configuration 00: MICBIAS = 1.04V (CM=0.75V) or MICBIAS = 1.25V(CM=0.9V) 01: MICBIAS = 1.425V(CM=0.75V) or MICBIAS = 1.7V(CM=0.9V) 10: MICBIAS = 2.075V(CM=0.75V) or MICBIAS = 2.5V(CM=0.9V) 11: MICBIAS is switch to power supply D3 R/W 0 0: MICBIAS voltage is generated from AVDD 1: MICBIAS voltage is generated from DRVdd_HP D2-D0 R 000 BIT DESCRIPTION Reserved. Write only default value. SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated Register Map 133 Page 1 Registers 5.3.26 www.ti.com Page 1 / Register 52: Left MICPGA Positive Terminal Input Routing Configuration Register - 0x01 / 0x34 BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7-D6 R/W 00 IN1L to Left MICPGA positive terminal selection 00: IN1L is not routed to Left MICPGA 01: IN1L is routed to Left MICPGA with 10K resistance 10: IN1L is routed to Left MICPGA with 20K resistance 11: IN1L is routed to Left MICPGA with 40K resistance D5-D4 R/W 00 IN2L to Left MICPGA positive terminal selection 00: IN2L is not routed to Left MICPGA 01: IN2L is routed to Left MICPGA with 10K resistance 10: IN2L is routed to Left MICPGA with 20K resistance 11: IN2L is routed to Left MICPGA with 40K resistance D3-D2 R/W 00 IN3L to Left MICPGA positive terminal selection 00: IN3L is not routed to Left MICPGA 01: IN3L is routed to Left MICPGA with 10K resistance 10: IN3L is routed to Left MICPGA with 20K resistance 11: IN3L is routed to Left MICPGA with 40K resistance D1-D0 R/W 00 IN1R to Left MICPGA positive terminal selection 00: IN1R is not routed to Left MICPGA 01: IN1R is routed to Left MICPGA with 10K resistance 10: IN1R is routed to Left MICPGA with 20K resistance 11: IN1R is routed to Left MICPGA with 40K resistance 5.3.27 Page 1 / Register 53: Reserved Register - 0x01 / 0x35 BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7-D0 R 0000 0000 5.3.28 DESCRIPTION DESCRIPTION Reserved. Write only default values Page 1 / Register 54: Left MICPGA Negative Terminal Input Routing Configuration Register - 0x01 / 0x36 BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7-D6 R/W 00 CM to Left MICPGA (CM1L) positive terminal selection 00: CM is not routed to Left MICPGA 01: CM is routed to Left MICPGA via CM1L with 10K resistance 10: CM is routed to Left MICPGA via CM1L with 20K resistance 11: CM is routed to Left MICPGA via CM1L with 40K resistance D5-D4 R/W 00 IN2R to Left MICPGA positive terminal selection 00: IN2R is not routed to Left MICPGA 01: IN2R is routed to Left MICPGA with 10K resistance 10: IN2R is routed to Left MICPGA with 20K resistance 11: IN2R is routed to Left MICPGA with 40K resistance D3-D2 R/W 00 IN3R to Left MICPGA positive terminal selection 00: IN3R is not routed to Left MICPGA 01: IN3R is routed to Left MICPGA with 10K resistance 10: IN3R is routed to Left MICPGA with 20K resistance 11: IN3R is routed to Left MICPGA with 40K resistance D1-D0 R/W 00 CM to Left MICPGA (CM2L) positive terminal selection 00: CM is not routed to Left MICPGA 01: CM is routed to Left MICPGA via CM2L with 10K resistance 10: CM is routed to Left MICPGA via CM2L with 20K resistance 11: CM is routed to Left MICPGA via CM2L with 40K resistance 5.3.29 134 DESCRIPTION Page 1 / Register 55: Right MICPGA Positive Terminal Input Routing Configuration Register Map SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated Page 1 Registers www.ti.com Register - 0x01 / 0x37 BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7-D6 R/W 00 IN1R to Right MICPGA positive terminal selection 00: IN1R is not routed to Right MICPGA 01: IN1R is routed to Right MICPGA with 10K resistance 10: IN1R is routed to Right MICPGA with 20K resistance 11: IN1R is routed to Right MICPGA with 40K resistance D5-D4 R/W 00 IN2R to Right MICPGA positive terminal selection 00: IN2R is not routed to Right MICPGA 01: IN2R is routed to Right MICPGA with 10K resistance 10: IN2R is routed to Right MICPGA with 20K resistance 11: IN2R is routed to Right MICPGA with 40K resistance D3-D2 R/W 00 IN3R to Right MICPGA positive terminal selection 00: IN3R is not routed to Right MICPGA 01: IN3R is routed to Right MICPGA with 10K resistance 10: IN3R is routed to Right MICPGA with 20K resistance 11: IN3R is routed to Right MICPGA with 40K resistance D1-D0 R/W 00 IN2L to Right MICPGA positive terminal selection 00: IN2L is not routed to Right MICPGA 01: IN2L is routed to Right MICPGA with 10K resistance 10: IN2L is routed to Right MICPGA with 20K resistance 11: IN2L is routed to Right MICPGA with 40K resistance 5.3.30 Page 1 / Register 56: Reserved Register - 0x01 / 0x38 BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7-D0 R 0000 0000 5.3.31 DESCRIPTION DESCRIPTION Reserved. Write only default values Page 1 / Register 57: Right MICPGA Negative Terminal Input Routing Configuration Register - 0x01 / 0x39 BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7-D6 R/W 00 CM to Right MICPGA (CM1R) positive terminal selection 00: CM is not routed to Right MICPGA 01: CM is routed to Right MICPGA via CM1R with 10K resistance 10: CM is routed to Right MICPGA via CM1R with 20K resistance 11: CM is routed to Right MICPGA via CM1R with 40K resistance D5-D4 R/W 00 IN1L to Right MICPGA positive terminal selection 00: IN1L is not routed to Right MICPGA 01: IN1L is routed to Right MICPGA with 10K resistance 10: IN1L is routed to Right MICPGA with 20K resistance 11: IN1L is routed to Right MICPGA with 40K resistance D3-D2 R/W 00 IN3L to Right MICPGA positive terminal selection 00: IN3L is not routed to Right MICPGA 01: IN3L is routed to Right MICPGA with 10K resistance 10: IN3L is routed to Right MICPGA with 20K resistance 11: IN3L is routed to Right MICPGA with 40K resistance D1-D0 R/W 00 CM to Right MICPGA (CM2R) positive terminal selection 00: CM is not routed to Right MICPGA 01: CM is routed to Right MICPGA via CM2R with 10K resistance 10: CM is routed to Right MICPGA via CM2R with 20K resistance 11: CM is routed to Right MICPGA via CM2R with 40K resistance 5.3.32 DESCRIPTION Page 1 / Register 58: Floating Input Configuration Register - 0x01 / 0x3A BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7 R/W 0 0: IN1L input is not weakly connected to common mode 1: IN1L input is weakly driven to common mode. Use when not routing IN1L to Left and Right MICPGA and HPL D6 R/W 0 0: IN1R input is not weakly connected to common mode 1: IN1R input is weakly driven to common mode. Use when not routing IN1L to Left and Right MICPGA and HPR DESCRIPTION SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated Register Map 135 Page 1 Registers www.ti.com Page 1 / Register 58: Floating Input Configuration Register - 0x01 / 0x3A (continued) BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D5 R/W 0 0: IN2L input is not weakly connected to common mode 1: IN2L input is weakly driven to common mode. Use when not routing IN2L to Left and Right MICPGA D4 R/W 0 0: IN2R input is not weakly connected to common mode 1: IN2R input is weakly driven to common mode. Use when not routing IN2R to Left and Right MICPGA D3 R/W 0 0: IN3L input is not weakly connected to common mode 1: IN3L input is weakly driven to common mode. Use when not routing IN3L to Left and Right MICPGA D2 R/W 0 0: IN3R input is not weakly connected to common mode 1: IN3R input is weakly driven to common mode. Use when not routing IN3R to Left and Right MICPGA D1-D0 R 00 Reserved. Write only default values 5.3.33 Page 1 / Register 59: Left MICPGA Volume Control Register - 0x01 / 0x3B BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7 R/W 1 D6-D0 R/W 000 0000 5.3.34 READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7 R/W 1 D6-D0 R/W 000 0000 READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7-D0 R/W 0000 0000 Left MICPGA Volume Control 000 0000: Volume Control = 0.0dB 000 0001: Volume Control = 0.5dB 000 0010: Volume Control = 1.0dB … 101 1101: Volume Control = 46.5dB 101 1110: Volume Control = 47.0dB 101 1111: Volume Control = 47.5dB 110 0000-111 1111: Reserved. Do not use DESCRIPTION 0: Right MICPGA Gain is enabled 1: Right MICPGA Gain is set to 0dB Right MICPGA Volume Control 000 0000: Volume Control = 0.0dB 000 0001: Volume Control = 0.5dB 000 0010: Volume Control = 1.0dB … 101 1101: Volume Control = 46.5dB 101 1110: Volume Control = 47.0dB 101 1111: Volume Control = 47.5dB 110 0000-111 1111: Reserved. Do not use DESCRIPTION 0000 0000: 0110 0100: 1011 0110: 1111 1111: PTM_R4 (Default) PTM_R3 PTM_R2 PTM_R1 Page 1 / Register 62: ADC Analog Volume Control Flag Register - 0x01 / 0x3E BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7-D2 R 00 0000 136 0: Left MICPGA Gain is enabled 1: Left MICPGA Gain is set to 0dB Page 1 / Register 61: ADC Power Tune Configuration Register - 0x01 / 0x3D BIT 5.3.36 DESCRIPTION Page 1 / Register 60: Right MICPGA Volume Control Register - 0x01 / 0x3C BIT 5.3.35 DESCRIPTION Register Map DESCRIPTION Reserved. Write only default values SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated Page 1 Registers www.ti.com Page 1 / Register 62: ADC Analog Volume Control Flag Register - 0x01 / 0x3E (continued) BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D1 R 0 Left Channel Analog Volume Control Flag 0: Applied Volume is not equal to Programmed Volume 1: Applied Volume is equal to Programmed Volume D0 R 0 Right Channel Analog Volume Control Flag 0: Applied Volume is not equal to Programmed Volume 1: Applied Volume is equal to Programmed Volume 5.3.37 DESCRIPTION Page 1 / Register 63: DAC Analog Gain Control Flag Register - 0x01 / 0x3F BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7 R 0 HPL Gain Flag 0: Applied Gain is not equal to Programmed Gain 1: Applied Gain is equal to Programmed Gain D6 R 0 HPR Gain Flag 0: Applied Gain is not equal to Programmed Gain 1: Applied Gain is equal to Programmed Gain D5 R 0 LOL Gain Flag 0: Applied Gain is not equal to Programmed Gain 1: Applied Gain is equal to Programmed Gain D4 R 0 LOR Gain Flag 0: Applied Gain is not equal to Programmed Gain 1: Applied Gain is equal to Programmed Gain D3 R 0 IN1L to HPL Bypass Volume Flag 0: Applied Volume is not equal to Programmed Volume 1: Applied Volume is equal to Programmed Volume D2 R 0 IN1R to HPR Bypass Volume Flag 0: Applied Volume is not equal to Programmed Volume 1: Applied Volume is equal to Programmed Volume D1 R 0 MAL Volume Flag 0: Applied Volume is not equal to Programmed Volume 1: Applied Volume is equal to Programmed Volume D0 R 0 MAR Volume Flag 0: Applied Volume is not equal to Programmed Volume 1: Applied Volume is equal to Programmed Volume 5.3.38 Page 1 / Register 64-70: Reserved Register - 0x01 / 0x40-0x46 BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7-D0 R 0000 0000 5.3.39 BIT DESCRIPTION Reserved. Write only default values Page 1 / Register 71: Analog Input Quick Charging Configuration Register - 0x01 / 0x47 READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7-D6 R 00 D5-D0 R/W 00 0000 5.3.40 DESCRIPTION DESCRIPTION Reserved. Write only default values Analog inputs power up time 00 0000: Default. Use one of the values give below 11 0001: Analog inputs power up time is 3.1 ms 11 0010: Analog inputs power up time is 6.4 ms 11 0011: Analog inputs power up time is 1.6 ms Others: Do not use Page 1 / Register 72-122: Reserved Register - 0x01 / 0x48-0x7A BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7-D0 R 0000 0000 DESCRIPTION Reserved. Write only default values SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated Register Map 137 Page 1 Registers 5.3.41 www.ti.com Page 1 / Register 123: Reference Power-up Configuration Register - 0x01 / 0x7B BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7-D3 R 0 0000 D2-D0 R/W 000 5.3.42 DESCRIPTION Reserved. Write only default values Reference Power Up configuration 000: Reference will power up slowly when analog blocks are powered up 001: Reference will power up in 40ms when analog blocks are powered up 010: Reference will power up in 80ms when analog blocks are powered up 011: Reference will power up in 120ms when analog blocks are powered up 100: Force power up of reference. Power up will be slow 101: Force power up of reference. Power up time will be 40ms 110: Force power up of reference. Power up time will be 80ms 111: Force power up of reference. Power up time will be 120ms Page 1 / Register 124: Charge Pump Control Register - 0x01 / 0x7C BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE DESCRIPTION D7 R/W 0 D6-D4 R/W 000 Charge Pump Power Configuration 0: Charge Pump Configuration is for Peak Load Current 1: Charge Pump Configuration is for 1/8 x Peak Load Current .. 7: Charge Pump Configuration is for 7/8 x Peak Load Current D3-D0 R/W 0000 Charge Pump Clock Divide Control 0: Clock Divide = 16 * 4 = 64 1: Clock Divide = 1 * 4 = 4 2: Clock Divide = 2 * 4 = 8 .. 15: Clock Divide = 15 * 4 = 60 Note: To power up charge pump, please program Page 1 / Register 1 5.3.43 Reserved Page 1 / Register 125: Headphone Driver Configuration Register - 0x01 / 0x7D BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7 R/W 0 Headphone amplifier compensation adjustment For use with low capacitive loading at the headpone output (<100pF//10k) D6-D5 R/W 00 HPL and HPR Master Gain Control in Ground Centered Mode 0: HPL and HPR have independent Gain Control in Ground Centered Mode 1: HPR Gain acts as Master Gain in Ground Centered Mode 2: HPL Gain acts as Master Gain in Ground Centered Mode 3: Reserved. Do not use The use of D6:5=1 or 2 will lead to lower power consumption. For these power saving modes to operate correctly the gains of HPL and HPR need to be programmed to the same values in Page 1 / Register 16 and Page 1 / Register 17 D4 R/W 0 0: Disable Ground Centered Mode for Headphone Drivers 1: Enable Ground Centered Mode for Headphone Drivers The internal charge pump needs to be enabled if ground centered mode is enabled. Page 1 / Register 1 D1:0 D3-D2 R/W 00 Headphone Driver Power Configuration 0: Output Power Rating is 100%. 1: Output Power Rating is 75% 2: Output Power Rating is 50% 3: Output Power Ratign is 25% D1-D0 R/W 00 DC Offset Correction Configuration for Ground Centered Mode of Headphone Driver 0: DC Offset Correction is disabled 1: Reserved. 2: DC Offset Correction is enabled for all signal routings which are enabled for HPL and HPR 3: DC Offset Correction for all possible signal routings for HPL and HPR Note: Read status for HP amplifier from Page 1 / Register 2 138 Register Map DESCRIPTION SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated Page 8 Registers www.ti.com 5.3.44 Page 1 / Register 126-127: Reserved Register - 0x01 / 0x7E-0x7F BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7-D0 R 0000 0000 5.4 DESCRIPTION Reserved. Write only default values Page 8 Registers 5.4.1 Page 8 / Register 0: Page Select Register - 0x08 / 0x00 BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7-D0 R/W 0000 0000 5.4.2 DESCRIPTION Page Select Register 0-255: Selects the Register Page for next read or write command. Refer Table "Summary of Memory Map" for details. Page 8 / Register 1: ADC Adaptive Filter Configuration Register - 0x08 / 0x01 BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7-D3 R 0000 0 D2 R/W 0 ADC Adaptive Filtering Control 0: Adaptive Filtering disabled for ADC 1: Adaptive Filtering enabled for ADC D1 R 0 ADC Adaptive Filter Buffer Control Flag 0: In adaptive filter mode, ADC accesses ADC Coefficient Buffer-A and control interface accesses ADC Coefficient Buffer-B 1: In adaptive filter mode, ADC accesses ADC Coefficient Buffer-B and control interface accesses ADC Coefficient Buffer-A D0 R/W 0 ADC Adaptive Filter Buffer Switch control 0: ADC Coefficient Buffers will not be switched at next frame boundary 1: ADC Coefficient Buffers will be switched at next frame boundary, if in adaptive filtering mode. This will self clear on switching. 5.4.3 Reserved. Write only default values Page 8 / Register 1-7: Reserved - 0x08 / 0x01-0x07 BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7-D0 R 0000 0000 5.4.4 DESCRIPTION Reserved. Write only default values Page 8 / Register 8-127: ADC Coefficients Buffer-A C(0:29) - 0x08 / 0x08-0x7F BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7-D0 R/W xxxx xxxx 5.5 DESCRIPTION DESCRIPTION 24-bit coefficients C0 through C29 of ADC Coefficient Buffer-A. Refer to Table "ADC Coefficient Buffer A Map" for details When Page-8, Reg-01d, D2='0' (Adaptive filtering disabled) the read write access to these registers is allowed only when ADC channel is powered down Page 9-16 Registers 5.5.1 Page 9-16 / Register 0: Page Select Register - 0x09-0x10 / 0x00 BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7-D0 R/W 0000 0000 5.5.2 DESCRIPTION Page Select Register 0-255: Selects the Register Page for next read or write command. Refer Table "Summary of Memory Map" for details. Page 9-16 / Register 1-7: Reserved - 0x09-0x10 / 0x01-0x07 BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7-D0 R 0000 0000 DESCRIPTION Reserved. Write only default values SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated Register Map 139 Page 26-34 Registers 5.5.3 www.ti.com Page 9-16 / Register 8-127: ADC Coefficients Buffer-A C(30:255) - 0x09-0x10 / 0x08-0x7F BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7-D0 R/W xxxx xxxx 5.6 DESCRIPTION 24-bit coefficients ADC Coefficient Buffer-A. Refer to Table "ADC Coefficient Buffer A Map" for details When Page-8, Reg-01d, D2='0' (Adaptive filtering disabled) the read write access to these registers is allowed only when ADC channel is powered down Page 26-34 Registers 5.6.1 Page 26-34 / Register 0: Page Select Register - 0x1A-0x22 / 0x00 BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7-D0 R/W 0000 0000 5.6.2 Page Select Register 0-255: Selects the Register Page for next read or write command. Refer Table "Summary of Memory Map" for details. Page 26-34 / Register 1-7: Reserved. - 0x1A-0x22 / 0x01-0x07 BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7-D0 R 0000 0000 5.6.3 DESCRIPTION Reserved. Write only default values Page 26-34 / Register 8-127: ADC Coefficients Buffer-B C(0:255) - 0x1A-0x22 / 0x08-0x7F BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7-D0 R/W xxxx xxxx 5.7 DESCRIPTION DESCRIPTION 24-bit coefficients of ADC Coefficient Buffer-B. Refer to Table "ADC Coefficient Buffer B Map" for details When Page-8, Reg-01d, D2='0' (Adaptive filtering disabled) the read write access to these registers is allowed only when ADC channel is powered down Page 44 Registers 5.7.1 Page 44 / Register 0: Page Select Register - 0x2C / 0x00 BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7-D0 R/W 0000 0000 5.7.2 DESCRIPTION Page Select Register 0-255: Selects the Register Page for next read or write command. Refer Table "Summary of Memory Map" for details. Page 44 / Register 1: DAC Adaptive Filter Configuration Register - 0x2C / 0x01 READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7-D3 R 0000 0 D2 R/W 0 DAC Adaptive Filtering Control 0: Adaptive Filtering disabled for DAC 1: Adaptive Filtering enabled for DAC D1 R 0 DAC Adaptive Filter Buffer Control Flag 0: In adaptive filter mode, DAC accesses DAC Coefficient Buffer-A and control interface accesses DAC Coefficient Buffer-B 1: In adaptive filter mode, DAC accesses DAC Coefficient Buffer-B and control interface accesses DAC Coefficient Buffer-A D0 R/W 0 DAC Adaptive Filter Buffer Switch control 0: DAC Coefficient Buffers will not be switched at next frame boundary 1: DAC Coefficient Buffers will be switched at next frame boundary, if in adaptive filtering mode. This will self clear on switching. BIT 140 Register Map DESCRIPTION Reserved. Write only default values SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated Page 45-52 Registers www.ti.com 5.7.3 Page 44 / Register 2-7: Reserved - 0x2C / 0x02-0x07 BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7-D0 R 0000 0000 5.7.4 Reserved. Write only default values Page 44 / Register 8-127: DAC Coefficients Buffer-A C(0:29) - 0x2C / 0x08-0x7F BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7-D0 R/W xxxx xxxx 5.8 DESCRIPTION DESCRIPTION 24-bit coefficients C0 through C29 of DAC Coefficient Buffer-A. Refer to Table "DAC Coefficient Buffer A Map" for details When Page-44, Reg-01d, D2='0' (Adaptive filtering disabled) the read write access to these registers is allowed only when DAC channel is powered down Page 45-52 Registers 5.8.1 Page 45-52 / Register 0: Page Select Register - 0x2D-0x34 / 0x00 BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7-D0 R/W 0000 0000 5.8.2 Page Select Register 0-255: Selects the Register Page for next read or write command. Refer Table "Summary of Memory Map" for details. Page 45-52 / Register 1-7: Reserved. - 0x2D-0x34 / 0x01-0x07 BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7-D0 R 0000 0000 5.8.3 DESCRIPTION Reserved. Write only default values Page 45-52 / Register 8-127: DAC Coefficients Buffer-A C(30:255) - 0x2D-0x34 / 0x080x7F BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7-D0 R/W xxxx xxxx 5.9 DESCRIPTION DESCRIPTION 24-bit coefficients DAC Coefficient Buffer-A. Refer to Table "DAC Coefficient Buffer A Map" for details When Page-44, Reg-01d, D2='0' (Adaptive filtering disabled) the read write access to these registers is allowed only when DAC channel is powered down Page 62-70 Registers 5.9.1 Page 62-70 / Register 0: Page Select Register - 0x3E-0x46 / 0x00 BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7-D0 R/W 0000 0000 5.9.2 Page Select Register 0-255: Selects the Register Page for next read or write command. Refer Table "Summary of Memory Map" for details. Page 62-70 / Register 1-7: Reserved. - 0x3E-0x46 / 0x01-0x07 BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7-D0 R 0000 0000 5.9.3 DESCRIPTION DESCRIPTION Reserved. Write only default values Page 62-70 / Register 8-127: DAC Coefficients Buffer-B C(0:255) - 0x3E-0x46 / 0x08-0x7F BIT READ/ WRITE RESET VALUE D7-D0 R/W xxxx xxxx DESCRIPTION 24-bit coefficients of DAC Coefficient Buffer-B. Refer to Table "DAC Coefficient Buffer B Map" for details When Page-44, Reg-01d, D2='0' (Adaptive filtering disabled) the read write access to these registers is allowed only when DAC channel is powered down SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated Register Map 141 ADC Coefficients A+B www.ti.com 5.10 ADC Coefficients A+B Table 5-2. ADC Coefficient Buffer-A Map Coef No Page No Base Register Base Register + 0 Base Register + 1 Base Register + 2 Base Register + 3 C0 8 8 Coef(23:16) Coef(15:8) Coef(7:0) Reserved. C1 8 12 Coef(23:16) Coef(15:8) Coef(7:0) Reserved. .. .. .. .. .. .. C29 8 124 Coef(23:16) Coef(15:8) Coef(7:0) Reserved. C30 9 8 Coef(23:16) Coef(15:8) Coef(7:0) Reserved. .. .. .. .. .. .. C59 9 124 Coef(23:16) Coef(15:8) Coef(7:0) Reserved. C60 10 8 Coef(23:16) Coef(15:8) Coef(7:0) Reserved. .. .. .. .. .. .. C89 10 124 Coef(23:16) Coef(15:8) Coef(7:0) Reserved. C90 11 8 Coef(23:16) Coef(15:8) Coef(7:0) Reserved. .. .. .. .. .. .. C119 11 124 Coef(23:16) Coef(15:8) Coef(7:0) Reserved. C120 12 8 Coef(23:16) Coef(15:8) Coef(7:0) Reserved. .. .. .. .. .. .. C149 12 124 Coef(23:16) Coef(15:8) Coef(7:0) Reserved. C150 13 8 Coef(23:16) Coef(15:8) Coef(7:0) Reserved. .. .. .. .. .. .. C179 13 124 Coef(23:16) Coef(15:8) Coef(7:0) Reserved. C180 14 8 Coef(23:16) Coef(15:8) Coef(7:0) Reserved. .. .. .. .. .. .. C209 14 124 Coef(23:16) Coef(15:8) Coef(7:0) Reserved. C210 15 8 Coef(23:16) Coef(15:8) Coef(7:0) Reserved. .. .. .. .. .. .. C239 15 124 Coef(23:16) Coef(15:8) Coef(7:0) Reserved. C240 16 8 Coef(23:16) Coef(15:8) Coef(7:0) Reserved. .. .. .. .. .. .. 16 68 Coef(23:16) Coef(15:8) Coef(7:0) Reserved. C255 Table 5-3. ADC Coefficient Buffer-B Map Coef No Page No Base Register Base Register + 0 Base Register + 1 Base Register + 2 Base Register + 3 C0 26 8 Coef(23:16) Coef(15:8) Coef(7:0) Reserved. C1 26 12 Coef(23:16) Coef(15:8) Coef(7:0) Reserved. .. .. .. .. .. .. C29 26 124 Coef(23:16) Coef(15:8) Coef(7:0) Reserved. C30 27 8 Coef(23:16) Coef(15:8) Coef(7:0) Reserved. .. .. .. .. .. .. C59 27 124 Coef(23:16) Coef(15:8) Coef(7:0) Reserved. C60 28 8 Coef(23:16) Coef(15:8) Coef(7:0) Reserved. .. .. .. .. .. .. C89 28 124 Coef(23:16) Coef(15:8) Coef(7:0) Reserved. C90 29 8 Coef(23:16) Coef(15:8) Coef(7:0) Reserved. .. .. .. .. .. .. 29 124 Coef(23:16) Coef(15:8) Coef(7:0) Reserved. C119 142 Register Map SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated ADC Defaults www.ti.com Table 5-3. ADC Coefficient Buffer-B Map (continued) Coef No Page No Base Register Base Register + 0 Base Register + 1 Base Register + 2 Base Register + 3 C120 30 8 Coef(23:16) Coef(15:8) Coef(7:0) Reserved. .. .. .. .. .. .. C149 30 124 Coef(23:16) Coef(15:8) Coef(7:0) Reserved. C150 31 8 Coef(23:16) Coef(15:8) Coef(7:0) Reserved. .. .. .. .. .. .. C179 31 124 Coef(23:16) Coef(15:8) Coef(7:0) Reserved. C180 32 8 Coef(23:16) Coef(15:8) Coef(7:0) Reserved. .. .. .. .. .. .. C209 32 124 Coef(23:16) Coef(15:8) Coef(7:0) Reserved. C210 33 8 Coef(23:16) Coef(15:8) Coef(7:0) Reserved. .. .. .. .. .. .. C239 33 124 Coef(23:16) Coef(15:8) Coef(7:0) Reserved. C240 34 8 Coef(23:16) Coef(15:8) Coef(7:0) Reserved. .. .. .. .. .. .. 34 68 Coef(23:16) Coef(15:8) Coef(7:0) Reserved. C255 5.11 ADC Defaults Table 5-4. Default values of ADC Coefficients in Buffers A and B ADC BufferA,B Coefficients Default Value at reset C0 00000000H C1 01170000H C2 01170000H C3 7DD30000H C4 7FFFFF00H C5,C6 00000000H C7 7FFFFF00H C8,..,C11 00000000H C12 7FFFFF00H C13,..,C16 00000000H C17 7FFFFF00H C18,..,C21 00000000H C22 7FFFFF00H C23,..,C26 00000000H C27 7FFFFF00H C28,..,C35 00000000H C36 7FFFFF00H C37,C38 00000000H C39 7FFFFF00H C40,..,C43 00000000H C44 7FFFFF00H C45,..,C48 00000000H C49 7FFFFF00H SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated Register Map 143 DAC Coefficients A+B www.ti.com Table 5-4. Default values of ADC Coefficients in Buffers A and B (continued) ADC BufferA,B Coefficients Default Value at reset C50,..,C53 00000000H C54 7FFFFF00H C55,..,C58 00000000H C59 7FFFFF00H C60,..,C255 00000000H 5.12 DAC Coefficients A+B Table 5-5. DAC Coefficient Buffer-A Map Coef No Page No Base Register Base Register + 0 Base Register + 1 Base Register + 2 Base Register + 3 C0 44 8 Coef(23:16) Coef(15:8) Coef(7:0) Reserved. C1 44 12 Coef(23:16) Coef(15:8) Coef(7:0) Reserved. .. .. .. .. .. .. C29 44 124 Coef(23:16) Coef(15:8) Coef(7:0) Reserved. C30 45 8 Coef(23:16) Coef(15:8) Coef(7:0) Reserved. .. .. .. .. .. .. C59 45 124 Coef(23:16) Coef(15:8) Coef(7:0) Reserved. C60 46 8 Coef(23:16) Coef(15:8) Coef(7:0) Reserved. .. .. .. .. .. .. C89 46 124 Coef(23:16) Coef(15:8) Coef(7:0) Reserved. C90 47 8 Coef(23:16) Coef(15:8) Coef(7:0) Reserved. .. .. .. .. .. .. C119 47 124 Coef(23:16) Coef(15:8) Coef(7:0) Reserved. C120 48 8 Coef(23:16) Coef(15:8) Coef(7:0) Reserved. .. .. .. .. .. .. C149 48 124 Coef(23:16) Coef(15:8) Coef(7:0) Reserved. C150 49 8 Coef(23:16) Coef(15:8) Coef(7:0) Reserved. .. .. .. .. .. .. C179 49 124 Coef(23:16) Coef(15:8) Coef(7:0) Reserved. C180 50 8 Coef(23:16) Coef(15:8) Coef(7:0) Reserved. .. .. .. .. .. .. C209 50 124 Coef(23:16) Coef(15:8) Coef(7:0) Reserved. C210 51 8 Coef(23:16) Coef(15:8) Coef(7:0) Reserved. .. .. .. .. .. .. C239 51 124 Coef(23:16) Coef(15:8) Coef(7:0) Reserved. C240 52 8 Coef(23:16) Coef(15:8) Coef(7:0) Reserved. .. .. .. .. .. .. 52 68 Coef(23:16) Coef(15:8) Coef(7:0) Reserved. C255 Table 5-6. DAC Coefficient Buffer-B Map Coef No Page No Base Register Base Register + 0 Base Register + 1 Base Register + 2 Base Register + 3 C0 62 8 Coef(23:16) Coef(15:8) Coef(7:0) Reserved. C1 62 12 Coef(23:16) Coef(15:8) Coef(7:0) Reserved. 144 Register Map SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated DAC Defaults www.ti.com Table 5-6. DAC Coefficient Buffer-B Map (continued) Coef No Page No Base Register Base Register + 0 Base Register + 1 Base Register + 2 Base Register + 3 .. .. .. .. .. .. C29 62 124 Coef(23:16) Coef(15:8) Coef(7:0) Reserved. C30 63 8 Coef(23:16) Coef(15:8) Coef(7:0) Reserved. .. .. .. .. .. .. C59 63 124 Coef(23:16) Coef(15:8) Coef(7:0) Reserved. C60 64 8 Coef(23:16) Coef(15:8) Coef(7:0) Reserved. .. .. .. .. .. .. C89 64 124 Coef(23:16) Coef(15:8) Coef(7:0) Reserved. C90 65 8 Coef(23:16) Coef(15:8) Coef(7:0) Reserved. .. .. .. .. .. .. C119 65 124 Coef(23:16) Coef(15:8) Coef(7:0) Reserved. C120 66 8 Coef(23:16) Coef(15:8) Coef(7:0) Reserved. .. .. .. .. .. .. C149 66 124 Coef(23:16) Coef(15:8) Coef(7:0) Reserved. C150 67 8 Coef(23:16) Coef(15:8) Coef(7:0) Reserved. .. .. .. .. .. .. C179 67 124 Coef(23:16) Coef(15:8) Coef(7:0) Reserved. C180 68 8 Coef(23:16) Coef(15:8) Coef(7:0) Reserved. .. .. .. .. .. .. C209 68 124 Coef(23:16) Coef(15:8) Coef(7:0) Reserved. C210 69 8 Coef(23:16) Coef(15:8) Coef(7:0) Reserved. .. .. .. .. .. .. C239 69 124 Coef(23:16) Coef(15:8) Coef(7:0) Reserved. C240 70 8 Coef(23:16) Coef(15:8) Coef(7:0) Reserved. .. .. .. .. .. .. 70 68 Coef(23:16) Coef(15:8) Coef(7:0) Reserved. C255 5.13 DAC Defaults Table 5-7. Default values of DAC Coefficients in Buffers A and B DAC Buffer-A,B Coefficients Default Value at reset C0 00000000H C1 7FFFFF00H C2,..,C5 00000000H C6 7FFFFF00H C7,..,C10 00000000H C11 7FFFFF00H C12,..,C15 00000000H C16 7FFFFF00H C17,..,C20 00000000H C21 7FFFFF00H C22,..,C25 00000000H C26 7FFFFF00H C27,..,C30 00000000H C31,C32 00000000H C33 7FFFFF00H SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated Register Map 145 DAC Defaults www.ti.com Table 5-7. Default values of DAC Coefficients in Buffers A and B (continued) 146 DAC Buffer-A,B Coefficients Default Value at reset C34,..,C37 00000000H C38 7FFFFF00H C39,..,C42 00000000H C43 7FFFFF00H C44,..,C47 00000000H C48 7FFFFF00H C49,..,C52 00000000H C53 7FFFFF00H C54,..,C57 00000000H C58 7FFFFF00H C59,..,C64 00000000H C65 7FFFFF00H C66,C67 00000000H C68 7FFFFF00H C69,C70 00000000H C71 7FF70000H C72 10090000H C73 7FEF0000H C74,C75 00110000H C76 7FDE0000H C77,..,C255 00000000H Register Map SLAA463B – January 2011 – Revised December 2012 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011–2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated IMPORTANT NOTICE Texas Instruments Incorporated and its subsidiaries (TI) reserve the right to make corrections, enhancements, improvements and other changes to its semiconductor products and services per JESD46, latest issue, and to discontinue any product or service per JESD48, latest issue. Buyers should obtain the latest relevant information before placing orders and should verify that such information is current and complete. All semiconductor products (also referred to herein as “components”) are sold subject to TI’s terms and conditions of sale supplied at the time of order acknowledgment. TI warrants performance of its components to the specifications applicable at the time of sale, in accordance with the warranty in TI’s terms and conditions of sale of semiconductor products. Testing and other quality control techniques are used to the extent TI deems necessary to support this warranty. Except where mandated by applicable law, testing of all parameters of each component is not necessarily performed. TI assumes no liability for applications assistance or the design of Buyers’ products. Buyers are responsible for their products and applications using TI components. To minimize the risks associated with Buyers’ products and applications, Buyers should provide adequate design and operating safeguards. TI does not warrant or represent that any license, either express or implied, is granted under any patent right, copyright, mask work right, or other intellectual property right relating to any combination, machine, or process in which TI components or services are used. Information published by TI regarding third-party products or services does not constitute a license to use such products or services or a warranty or endorsement thereof. Use of such information may require a license from a third party under the patents or other intellectual property of the third party, or a license from TI under the patents or other intellectual property of TI. Reproduction of significant portions of TI information in TI data books or data sheets is permissible only if reproduction is without alteration and is accompanied by all associated warranties, conditions, limitations, and notices. TI is not responsible or liable for such altered documentation. Information of third parties may be subject to additional restrictions. Resale of TI components or services with statements different from or beyond the parameters stated by TI for that component or service voids all express and any implied warranties for the associated TI component or service and is an unfair and deceptive business practice. TI is not responsible or liable for any such statements. Buyer acknowledges and agrees that it is solely responsible for compliance with all legal, regulatory and safety-related requirements concerning its products, and any use of TI components in its applications, notwithstanding any applications-related information or support that may be provided by TI. Buyer represents and agrees that it has all the necessary expertise to create and implement safeguards which anticipate dangerous consequences of failures, monitor failures and their consequences, lessen the likelihood of failures that might cause harm and take appropriate remedial actions. Buyer will fully indemnify TI and its representatives against any damages arising out of the use of any TI components in safety-critical applications. In some cases, TI components may be promoted specifically to facilitate safety-related applications. With such components, TI’s goal is to help enable customers to design and create their own end-product solutions that meet applicable functional safety standards and requirements. Nonetheless, such components are subject to these terms. No TI components are authorized for use in FDA Class III (or similar life-critical medical equipment) unless authorized officers of the parties have executed a special agreement specifically governing such use. Only those TI components which TI has specifically designated as military grade or “enhanced plastic” are designed and intended for use in military/aerospace applications or environments. Buyer acknowledges and agrees that any military or aerospace use of TI components which have not been so designated is solely at the Buyer's risk, and that Buyer is solely responsible for compliance with all legal and regulatory requirements in connection with such use. TI has specifically designated certain components as meeting ISO/TS16949 requirements, mainly for automotive use. In any case of use of non-designated products, TI will not be responsible for any failure to meet ISO/TS16949. Products Applications Audio www.ti.com/audio Automotive and Transportation www.ti.com/automotive Amplifiers amplifier.ti.com Communications and Telecom www.ti.com/communications Data Converters dataconverter.ti.com Computers and Peripherals www.ti.com/computers DLP® Products www.dlp.com Consumer Electronics www.ti.com/consumer-apps DSP dsp.ti.com Energy and Lighting www.ti.com/energy Clocks and Timers www.ti.com/clocks Industrial www.ti.com/industrial Interface interface.ti.com Medical www.ti.com/medical Logic logic.ti.com Security www.ti.com/security Power Mgmt power.ti.com Space, Avionics and Defense www.ti.com/space-avionics-defense Microcontrollers microcontroller.ti.com Video and Imaging www.ti.com/video RFID www.ti-rfid.com OMAP Applications Processors www.ti.com/omap TI E2E Community e2e.ti.com Wireless Connectivity www.ti.com/wirelessconnectivity Mailing Address: Texas Instruments, Post Office Box 655303, Dallas, Texas 75265 Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated